Mercurial > emacs
annotate src/dispnew.c @ 112185:318f49ef9a11
* dbusbind.c (Fdbus_register_service): Raise an error in case of
unexpected return values.
(Fdbus_register_method): Remove connection initialization.
author | Michael Albinus <michael.albinus@gmx.de> |
---|---|
date | Mon, 10 Jan 2011 12:28:31 +0100 |
parents | ac49e05bfcf2 |
children | 417b1e4d63cd 7df2e30d72ec |
rev | line source |
---|---|
314 | 1 /* Updating of data structures for redisplay. |
64770
a0d1312ede66
Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
64084
diff
changeset
|
2 Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1987, 1988, 1993, 1994, 1995, |
a0d1312ede66
Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents:
64084
diff
changeset
|
3 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, |
106815 | 4 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
314 | 5 |
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs. | |
7 | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
94946
diff
changeset
|
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify |
314 | 9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
94946
diff
changeset
|
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or |
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
94946
diff
changeset
|
11 (at your option) any later version. |
314 | 12 |
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
16 GNU General Public License for more details. | |
17 | |
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
94946
diff
changeset
|
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ |
314 | 20 |
26088
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
21 #include <config.h> |
314 | 22 #include <signal.h> |
7900
60795e826dad
Put stdio.h after config.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7814
diff
changeset
|
23 #include <stdio.h> |
314 | 24 #include <ctype.h> |
105669
68dd71358159
* alloc.c: Do not define struct catchtag.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
104957
diff
changeset
|
25 #include <setjmp.h> |
314 | 26 |
21514 | 27 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H |
28 #include <unistd.h> | |
29 #endif | |
30 | |
3525
58e789baa27a
Include lisp.h earlier (before termhooks.h).
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3517
diff
changeset
|
31 #include "lisp.h" |
314 | 32 #include "termchar.h" |
33 #include "termopts.h" | |
13526
34382f4e23cb
Always include dispextern.h before cm.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13448
diff
changeset
|
34 /* cm.h must come after dispextern.h on Windows. */ |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
35 #include "dispextern.h" |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
36 #include "cm.h" |
314 | 37 #include "buffer.h" |
88351
aac41b50c875
Include "character.h" instead of "charset.h".
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
42835
diff
changeset
|
38 #include "character.h" |
31093
6da961dff718
Include keyboard.h before frame.h.
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
30720
diff
changeset
|
39 #include "keyboard.h" |
764 | 40 #include "frame.h" |
83004
7900111db01c
Converted display hooks to be display-local. Plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82995
diff
changeset
|
41 #include "termhooks.h" |
314 | 42 #include "window.h" |
43 #include "commands.h" | |
44 #include "disptab.h" | |
45 #include "indent.h" | |
4384
98605d0ea3cf
(direct_output_for_insert): Fail if character
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
4290
diff
changeset
|
46 #include "intervals.h" |
15065 | 47 #include "blockinput.h" |
21514 | 48 #include "process.h" |
314 | 49 |
12917 | 50 #include "syssignal.h" |
554 | 51 |
314 | 52 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS |
53 #include "xterm.h" | |
25012 | 54 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ |
314 | 55 |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
56 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
57 #include "w32term.h" |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
58 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */ |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
59 |
96675
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
60 #ifdef HAVE_NS |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
61 #include "nsterm.h" |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
62 #endif |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
63 |
25012 | 64 /* Include systime.h after xterm.h to avoid double inclusion of time.h. */ |
65 | |
7808
52e2eb6245d4
Include systime.h after xterm.h.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7648
diff
changeset
|
66 #include "systime.h" |
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
67 #include <errno.h> |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
68 |
314 | 69 /* Get number of chars of output now in the buffer of a stdio stream. |
25012 | 70 This ought to be built in in stdio, but it isn't. Some s- files |
71 override this because their stdio internals differ. */ | |
72 | |
5214
c4bf07b226be
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) [__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Alternate definition for the GNU
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
5083
diff
changeset
|
73 #ifdef __GNU_LIBRARY__ |
25012 | 74 |
75 /* The s- file might have overridden the definition with one that | |
76 works for the system's C library. But we are using the GNU C | |
77 library, so this is the right definition for every system. */ | |
78 | |
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
79 #ifdef GNU_LIBRARY_PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
80 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT GNU_LIBRARY_PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
81 #else |
7443
a9cb818e5316
[__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Redefine PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT even if already defined.
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
7247
diff
changeset
|
82 #undef PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
5214
c4bf07b226be
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) [__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Alternate definition for the GNU
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
5083
diff
changeset
|
83 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) ((FILE)->__bufp - (FILE)->__buffer) |
7558
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
84 #endif |
8497bcb9fb8e
(PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT): If __GNU_LIBRARY__,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7530
diff
changeset
|
85 #else /* not __GNU_LIBRARY__ */ |
26088
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
86 #if !defined (PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT) && HAVE_STDIO_EXT_H && HAVE___FPENDING |
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
87 #include <stdio_ext.h> |
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
88 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) __fpending (FILE) |
b7aa6ac26872
Add support for large files, 64-bit Solaris, system locale codings.
Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>
parents:
25781
diff
changeset
|
89 #endif |
7443
a9cb818e5316
[__GNU_LIBRARY__]: Redefine PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT even if already defined.
Roland McGrath <roland@gnu.org>
parents:
7247
diff
changeset
|
90 #ifndef PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT |
314 | 91 #define PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT(FILE) ((FILE)->_ptr - (FILE)->_base) |
92 #endif | |
25012 | 93 #endif /* not __GNU_LIBRARY__ */ |
94 | |
41969
e669966d496e
Test GNU_LINUX, not LINUX.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
95 #if defined(HAVE_TERM_H) && defined (GNU_LINUX) && defined (HAVE_LIBNCURSES) |
29437 | 96 #include <term.h> /* for tgetent */ |
97 #endif | |
25012 | 98 |
99 /* Structure to pass dimensions around. Used for character bounding | |
100 boxes, glyph matrix dimensions and alike. */ | |
101 | |
102 struct dim | |
103 { | |
104 int width; | |
105 int height; | |
106 }; | |
107 | |
108 | |
109 /* Function prototypes. */ | |
110 | |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
111 static struct glyph_matrix *save_current_matrix (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
112 static void restore_current_matrix (struct frame *, struct glyph_matrix *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
113 static int showing_window_margins_p (struct window *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
114 static void fake_current_matrices (Lisp_Object); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
115 static void redraw_overlapping_rows (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
116 static void redraw_overlapped_rows (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
117 static int count_blanks (struct glyph *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
118 static int count_match (struct glyph *, struct glyph *, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
119 struct glyph *, struct glyph *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
120 static unsigned line_draw_cost (struct glyph_matrix *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
121 static void update_frame_line (struct frame *, int); |
25012 | 122 static struct dim allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
123 (Lisp_Object, int, int, int, int *); |
112023
ac49e05bfcf2
Remove unused declarations
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
112021
diff
changeset
|
124 static int required_matrix_height (struct window *); |
ac49e05bfcf2
Remove unused declarations
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
112021
diff
changeset
|
125 static int required_matrix_width (struct window *); |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
126 static void allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (struct window *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
127 static int realloc_glyph_pool (struct glyph_pool *, struct dim); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
128 static void adjust_frame_glyphs (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
129 struct glyph_matrix *new_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_pool *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
130 static void free_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
131 static void adjust_glyph_matrix (struct window *, struct glyph_matrix *, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
132 int, int, struct dim); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
133 static void change_frame_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int, int, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
134 static void swap_glyph_pointers (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph_row *); |
34895
53e52b3525bf
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34893
diff
changeset
|
135 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
136 static int glyph_row_slice_p (struct glyph_row *, struct glyph_row *); |
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
137 #endif |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
138 static void fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (struct glyph_row *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
139 static void build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (struct glyph_matrix *, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
140 struct window *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
141 static void build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (struct glyph_matrix *, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
142 struct window *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
143 static struct glyph_pool *new_glyph_pool (void); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
144 static void free_glyph_pool (struct glyph_pool *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
145 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (void); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
146 static void adjust_frame_message_buffer (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
147 static void adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
148 static void fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (struct glyph_row *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
149 static void build_frame_matrix (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
150 void clear_current_matrices (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
151 void scroll_glyph_matrix_range (struct glyph_matrix *, int, int, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
152 int, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
153 static void clear_window_matrices (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
154 static void fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (struct glyph_row *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
155 static int scrolling_window (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
156 static int update_window_line (struct window *, int, int *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
157 static void update_marginal_area (struct window *, int, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
158 static int update_text_area (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
159 static void make_current (struct glyph_matrix *, struct glyph_matrix *, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
160 int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
161 static void mirror_make_current (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
162 void check_window_matrix_pointers (struct window *); |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
163 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
164 static void check_matrix_pointers (struct glyph_matrix *, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
165 struct glyph_matrix *); |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
166 #endif |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
167 static void mirror_line_dance (struct window *, int, int, int *, char *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
168 static int update_window_tree (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
169 static int update_window (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
170 static int update_frame_1 (struct frame *, int, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
171 static void set_window_cursor_after_update (struct window *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
172 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (struct frame *); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
173 static void adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (struct frame *); |
25012 | 174 |
175 | |
176 /* Non-zero means don't pause redisplay for pending input. (This is | |
177 for debugging and for a future implementation of EDT-like | |
178 scrolling. */ | |
179 | |
180 int redisplay_dont_pause; | |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
181 |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
182 /* Define PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING to 1, if micro-second timers |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
183 are supported, so we can check for input during redisplay at |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
184 regular intervals. */ |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
185 #ifdef EMACS_HAS_USECS |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
186 #define PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING 1 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
187 #else |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
188 #define PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING 0 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
189 #endif |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
190 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
191 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
192 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
193 /* If a number (float), check for user input every N seconds. */ |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
194 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
195 Lisp_Object Vredisplay_preemption_period; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
196 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
197 /* Redisplay preemption timers. */ |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
198 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
199 static EMACS_TIME preemption_period; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
200 static EMACS_TIME preemption_next_check; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
201 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
202 #endif |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
203 |
554 | 204 /* Nonzero upon entry to redisplay means do not assume anything about |
764 | 205 current contents of actual terminal frame; clear and redraw it. */ |
314 | 206 |
764 | 207 int frame_garbaged; |
314 | 208 |
25012 | 209 /* Nonzero means last display completed. Zero means it was preempted. */ |
314 | 210 |
211 int display_completed; | |
212 | |
25012 | 213 /* Lisp variable visible-bell; enables use of screen-flash instead of |
214 audible bell. */ | |
314 | 215 |
216 int visible_bell; | |
217 | |
764 | 218 /* Invert the color of the whole frame, at a low level. */ |
314 | 219 |
220 int inverse_video; | |
221 | |
222 /* Line speed of the terminal. */ | |
223 | |
43713
f92c4d87863a
Change defvar_int def and vars to use EMACS_INT instead of just int.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
42835
diff
changeset
|
224 EMACS_INT baud_rate; |
314 | 225 |
25012 | 226 /* Either nil or a symbol naming the window system under which Emacs |
83014
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
227 creates the first frame. */ |
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
228 |
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
229 Lisp_Object Vinitial_window_system; |
314 | 230 |
231 /* Version number of X windows: 10, 11 or nil. */ | |
25012 | 232 |
314 | 233 Lisp_Object Vwindow_system_version; |
234 | |
25012 | 235 /* Vector of glyph definitions. Indexed by glyph number, the contents |
236 are a string which is how to output the glyph. | |
314 | 237 |
238 If Vglyph_table is nil, a glyph is output by using its low 8 bits | |
25012 | 239 as a character code. |
240 | |
241 This is an obsolete feature that is no longer used. The variable | |
242 is retained for compatibility. */ | |
314 | 243 |
244 Lisp_Object Vglyph_table; | |
245 | |
246 /* Display table to use for vectors that don't specify their own. */ | |
247 | |
248 Lisp_Object Vstandard_display_table; | |
249 | |
25012 | 250 /* Nonzero means reading single-character input with prompt so put |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
251 cursor on mini-buffer after the prompt. Positive means at end of |
25012 | 252 text in echo area; negative means at beginning of line. */ |
253 | |
314 | 254 int cursor_in_echo_area; |
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
255 |
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
256 Lisp_Object Qdisplay_table, Qredisplay_dont_pause; |
25012 | 257 |
314 | 258 |
25012 | 259 /* The currently selected frame. In a single-frame version, this |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
260 variable always equals the_only_frame. */ |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
261 |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
262 Lisp_Object selected_frame; |
25012 | 263 |
264 /* A frame which is not just a mini-buffer, or 0 if there are no such | |
764 | 265 frames. This is usually the most recent such frame that was |
9572 | 266 selected. In a single-frame version, this variable always holds |
267 the address of the_only_frame. */ | |
25012 | 268 |
269 struct frame *last_nonminibuf_frame; | |
270 | |
271 /* 1 means SIGWINCH happened when not safe. */ | |
272 | |
273 int delayed_size_change; | |
274 | |
275 /* 1 means glyph initialization has been completed at startup. */ | |
276 | |
277 static int glyphs_initialized_initially_p; | |
278 | |
279 /* Updated window if != 0. Set by update_window. */ | |
280 | |
281 struct window *updated_window; | |
282 | |
283 /* Glyph row updated in update_window_line, and area that is updated. */ | |
284 | |
285 struct glyph_row *updated_row; | |
286 int updated_area; | |
287 | |
288 /* A glyph for a space. */ | |
289 | |
290 struct glyph space_glyph; | |
291 | |
292 /* Counts of allocated structures. These counts serve to diagnose | |
293 memory leaks and double frees. */ | |
294 | |
295 int glyph_matrix_count; | |
296 int glyph_pool_count; | |
297 | |
298 /* If non-null, the frame whose frame matrices are manipulated. If | |
299 null, window matrices are worked on. */ | |
300 | |
301 static struct frame *frame_matrix_frame; | |
302 | |
303 /* Non-zero means that fonts have been loaded since the last glyph | |
304 matrix adjustments. Redisplay must stop, and glyph matrices must | |
305 be adjusted when this flag becomes non-zero during display. The | |
306 reason fonts can be loaded so late is that fonts of fontsets are | |
94946
6009a07ef854
(fonts_changed_p): Comment improved.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
94909
diff
changeset
|
307 loaded on demand. Another reason is that a line contains many |
6009a07ef854
(fonts_changed_p): Comment improved.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
94909
diff
changeset
|
308 characters displayed by zero width or very narrow glyphs of |
6009a07ef854
(fonts_changed_p): Comment improved.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
94909
diff
changeset
|
309 variable-width fonts. */ |
25012 | 310 |
311 int fonts_changed_p; | |
312 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
313 /* Convert vpos and hpos from frame to window and vice versa. |
25012 | 314 This may only be used for terminal frames. */ |
315 | |
316 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
317 | |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
318 static int window_to_frame_vpos (struct window *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
319 static int window_to_frame_hpos (struct window *, int); |
25012 | 320 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS(W, VPOS) window_to_frame_vpos ((W), (VPOS)) |
321 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS(W, HPOS) window_to_frame_hpos ((W), (HPOS)) | |
322 | |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
323 /* One element of the ring buffer containing redisplay history |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
324 information. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
325 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
326 struct redisplay_history |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
327 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
328 char trace[512 + 100]; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
329 }; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
330 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
331 /* The size of the history buffer. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
332 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
333 #define REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE 30 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
334 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
335 /* The redisplay history buffer. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
336 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
337 static struct redisplay_history redisplay_history[REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE]; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
338 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
339 /* Next free entry in redisplay_history. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
340 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
341 static int history_idx; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
342 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
343 /* A tick that's incremented each time something is added to the |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
344 history. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
345 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
346 static unsigned history_tick; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
347 |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
348 static void add_frame_display_history (struct frame *, int); |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108909
diff
changeset
|
349 static void add_window_display_history (struct window *, char *, int); |
71141 | 350 |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
351 /* Add to the redisplay history how window W has been displayed. |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
352 MSG is a trace containing the information how W's glyph matrix |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
353 has been constructed. PAUSED_P non-zero means that the update |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
354 has been interrupted for pending input. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
355 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
356 static void |
112021 | 357 add_window_display_history (struct window *w, char *msg, int paused_p) |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
358 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
359 char *buf; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
360 |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
361 if (history_idx >= REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
362 history_idx = 0; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
363 buf = redisplay_history[history_idx].trace; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
364 ++history_idx; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
365 |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
366 sprintf (buf, "%d: window %p (`%s')%s\n", |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
367 history_tick++, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
368 w, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
369 ((BUFFERP (w->buffer) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
370 && STRINGP (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->name)) |
46370
40db0673e6f0
Most uses of XSTRING combined with STRING_BYTES or indirection changed to
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
46293
diff
changeset
|
371 ? (char *) SDATA (XBUFFER (w->buffer)->name) |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
372 : "???"), |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
373 paused_p ? " ***paused***" : ""); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
374 strcat (buf, msg); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
375 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
376 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
377 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
378 /* Add to the redisplay history that frame F has been displayed. |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
379 PAUSED_P non-zero means that the update has been interrupted for |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
380 pending input. */ |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
381 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
382 static void |
112021 | 383 add_frame_display_history (struct frame *f, int paused_p) |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
384 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
385 char *buf; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
386 |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
387 if (history_idx >= REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
388 history_idx = 0; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
389 buf = redisplay_history[history_idx].trace; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
390 ++history_idx; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
391 |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
392 sprintf (buf, "%d: update frame %p%s", |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
393 history_tick++, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
394 f, paused_p ? " ***paused***" : ""); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
395 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
396 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
397 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
398 DEFUN ("dump-redisplay-history", Fdump_redisplay_history, |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
399 Sdump_redisplay_history, 0, 0, "", |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
400 doc: /* Dump redisplay history to stderr. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
401 (void) |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
402 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
403 int i; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
404 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
405 for (i = history_idx - 1; i != history_idx; --i) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
406 { |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
407 if (i < 0) |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
408 i = REDISPLAY_HISTORY_SIZE - 1; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
409 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", redisplay_history[i].trace); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
410 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
411 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
412 return Qnil; |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
413 } |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
414 |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
415 |
25012 | 416 #else /* GLYPH_DEBUG == 0 */ |
417 | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
418 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS(W, VPOS) ((VPOS) + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (W)) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
419 #define WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS(W, HPOS) ((HPOS) + WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_COL (W)) |
25012 | 420 |
421 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG == 0 */ | |
422 | |
423 | |
109539
d962ccf8829f
Use __executable_start to find start of text segment for profiling
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109360
diff
changeset
|
424 #if defined PROFILING && !HAVE___EXECUTABLE_START |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
425 /* FIXME: only used to find text start for profiling. */ |
314 | 426 |
427 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
428 safe_bcopy (const char *from, char *to, int size) |
314 | 429 { |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
430 abort (); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
431 } |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
432 #endif |
25012 | 433 |
434 /*********************************************************************** | |
435 Glyph Matrices | |
436 ***********************************************************************/ | |
437 | |
438 /* Allocate and return a glyph_matrix structure. POOL is the glyph | |
439 pool from which memory for the matrix should be allocated, or null | |
440 for window-based redisplay where no glyph pools are used. The | |
441 member `pool' of the glyph matrix structure returned is set to | |
442 POOL, the structure is otherwise zeroed. */ | |
443 | |
444 struct glyph_matrix * | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
445 new_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_pool *pool) |
25012 | 446 { |
447 struct glyph_matrix *result; | |
448 | |
449 /* Allocate and clear. */ | |
450 result = (struct glyph_matrix *) xmalloc (sizeof *result); | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
451 memset (result, 0, sizeof *result); |
25012 | 452 |
453 /* Increment number of allocated matrices. This count is used | |
454 to detect memory leaks. */ | |
455 ++glyph_matrix_count; | |
456 | |
457 /* Set pool and return. */ | |
458 result->pool = pool; | |
459 return result; | |
460 } | |
461 | |
462 | |
463 /* Free glyph matrix MATRIX. Passing in a null MATRIX is allowed. | |
464 | |
465 The global counter glyph_matrix_count is decremented when a matrix | |
466 is freed. If the count gets negative, more structures were freed | |
467 than allocated, i.e. one matrix was freed more than once or a bogus | |
468 pointer was passed to this function. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
469 |
25012 | 470 If MATRIX->pool is null, this means that the matrix manages its own |
471 glyph memory---this is done for matrices on X frames. Freeing the | |
472 matrix also frees the glyph memory in this case. */ | |
473 | |
474 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
475 free_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix) |
25012 | 476 { |
477 if (matrix) | |
478 { | |
479 int i; | |
480 | |
481 /* Detect the case that more matrices are freed than were | |
482 allocated. */ | |
483 if (--glyph_matrix_count < 0) | |
484 abort (); | |
485 | |
486 /* Free glyph memory if MATRIX owns it. */ | |
487 if (matrix->pool == NULL) | |
488 for (i = 0; i < matrix->rows_allocated; ++i) | |
489 xfree (matrix->rows[i].glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
490 |
25012 | 491 /* Free row structures and the matrix itself. */ |
492 xfree (matrix->rows); | |
493 xfree (matrix); | |
494 } | |
495 } | |
496 | |
497 | |
498 /* Return the number of glyphs to reserve for a marginal area of | |
499 window W. TOTAL_GLYPHS is the number of glyphs in a complete | |
500 display line of window W. MARGIN gives the width of the marginal | |
501 area in canonical character units. MARGIN should be an integer | |
502 or a float. */ | |
503 | |
504 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
505 margin_glyphs_to_reserve (struct window *w, int total_glyphs, Lisp_Object margin) |
25012 | 506 { |
507 int n; | |
508 | |
509 if (NUMBERP (margin)) | |
510 { | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
511 int width = XFASTINT (w->total_cols); |
25012 | 512 double d = max (0, XFLOATINT (margin)); |
513 d = min (width / 2 - 1, d); | |
57808
a1c4ff636947
(margin_glyphs_to_reserve): Don't use ncols_scale_factor.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
56727
diff
changeset
|
514 n = (int) ((double) total_glyphs / width * d); |
25012 | 515 } |
516 else | |
517 n = 0; | |
518 | |
519 return n; | |
520 } | |
521 | |
522 | |
523 /* Adjust glyph matrix MATRIX on window W or on a frame to changed | |
524 window sizes. | |
525 | |
526 W is null if the function is called for a frame glyph matrix. | |
527 Otherwise it is the window MATRIX is a member of. X and Y are the | |
528 indices of the first column and row of MATRIX within the frame | |
529 matrix, if such a matrix exists. They are zero for purely | |
530 window-based redisplay. DIM is the needed size of the matrix. | |
531 | |
532 In window-based redisplay, where no frame matrices exist, glyph | |
533 matrices manage their own glyph storage. Otherwise, they allocate | |
534 storage from a common frame glyph pool which can be found in | |
535 MATRIX->pool. | |
536 | |
537 The reason for this memory management strategy is to avoid complete | |
538 frame redraws if possible. When we allocate from a common pool, a | |
539 change of the location or size of a sub-matrix within the pool | |
540 requires a complete redisplay of the frame because we cannot easily | |
541 make sure that the current matrices of all windows still agree with | |
542 what is displayed on the screen. While this is usually fast, it | |
543 leads to screen flickering. */ | |
544 | |
545 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
546 adjust_glyph_matrix (struct window *w, struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int x, int y, struct dim dim) |
25012 | 547 { |
548 int i; | |
549 int new_rows; | |
550 int marginal_areas_changed_p = 0; | |
25546 | 551 int header_line_changed_p = 0; |
552 int header_line_p = 0; | |
25012 | 553 int left = -1, right = -1; |
80274
b818bce5757f
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Initialize window_height.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
79759
diff
changeset
|
554 int window_width = -1, window_height = -1; |
25012 | 555 |
52377
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
556 /* See if W had a header line that has disappeared now, or vice versa. |
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
557 Get W's size. */ |
25012 | 558 if (w) |
559 { | |
52377
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
560 window_box (w, -1, 0, 0, &window_width, &window_height); |
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
561 |
25546 | 562 header_line_p = WINDOW_WANTS_HEADER_LINE_P (w); |
563 header_line_changed_p = header_line_p != matrix->header_line_p; | |
25012 | 564 } |
25546 | 565 matrix->header_line_p = header_line_p; |
25012 | 566 |
52377
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
567 /* If POOL is null, MATRIX is a window matrix for window-based redisplay. |
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
568 Do nothing if MATRIX' size, position, vscroll, and marginal areas |
25012 | 569 haven't changed. This optimization is important because preserving |
570 the matrix means preventing redisplay. */ | |
571 if (matrix->pool == NULL) | |
572 { | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
573 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, w->left_margin_cols); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
574 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, w->right_margin_cols); |
25012 | 575 xassert (left >= 0 && right >= 0); |
576 marginal_areas_changed_p = (left != matrix->left_margin_glyphs | |
577 || right != matrix->right_margin_glyphs); | |
578 | |
579 if (!marginal_areas_changed_p | |
580 && !fonts_changed_p | |
25546 | 581 && !header_line_changed_p |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
582 && matrix->window_left_col == WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_COL (w) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
583 && matrix->window_top_line == WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) |
25012 | 584 && matrix->window_height == window_height |
585 && matrix->window_vscroll == w->vscroll | |
586 && matrix->window_width == window_width) | |
587 return; | |
588 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
589 |
25012 | 590 /* Enlarge MATRIX->rows if necessary. New rows are cleared. */ |
591 if (matrix->rows_allocated < dim.height) | |
592 { | |
593 int size = dim.height * sizeof (struct glyph_row); | |
594 new_rows = dim.height - matrix->rows_allocated; | |
595 matrix->rows = (struct glyph_row *) xrealloc (matrix->rows, size); | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
596 memset (matrix->rows + matrix->rows_allocated, 0, |
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
597 new_rows * sizeof *matrix->rows); |
25012 | 598 matrix->rows_allocated = dim.height; |
599 } | |
600 else | |
601 new_rows = 0; | |
602 | |
603 /* If POOL is not null, MATRIX is a frame matrix or a window matrix | |
604 on a frame not using window-based redisplay. Set up pointers for | |
605 each row into the glyph pool. */ | |
606 if (matrix->pool) | |
607 { | |
608 xassert (matrix->pool->glyphs); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
609 |
25012 | 610 if (w) |
611 { | |
612 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
613 w->left_margin_cols); |
25012 | 614 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
615 w->right_margin_cols); |
25012 | 616 } |
617 else | |
618 left = right = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
619 |
25012 | 620 for (i = 0; i < dim.height; ++i) |
621 { | |
622 struct glyph_row *row = &matrix->rows[i]; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
623 |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
624 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] |
25012 | 625 = (matrix->pool->glyphs |
626 + (y + i) * matrix->pool->ncolumns | |
627 + x); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
628 |
25012 | 629 if (w == NULL |
630 || row == matrix->rows + dim.height - 1 | |
25546 | 631 || (row == matrix->rows && matrix->header_line_p)) |
25012 | 632 { |
633 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
634 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
635 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
636 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width; | |
637 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
638 = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
639 } | |
640 else | |
641 { | |
642 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
643 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; | |
644 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
645 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width - left - right; | |
646 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
647 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + dim.width; | |
648 } | |
649 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
650 |
25012 | 651 matrix->left_margin_glyphs = left; |
652 matrix->right_margin_glyphs = right; | |
653 } | |
654 else | |
655 { | |
656 /* If MATRIX->pool is null, MATRIX is responsible for managing | |
52377
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
657 its own memory. It is a window matrix for window-based redisplay. |
a90dea69e764
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Call window_box whenever W is nonzero.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
51413
diff
changeset
|
658 Allocate glyph memory from the heap. */ |
25012 | 659 if (dim.width > matrix->matrix_w |
660 || new_rows | |
25546 | 661 || header_line_changed_p |
25012 | 662 || marginal_areas_changed_p) |
663 { | |
664 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows; | |
665 struct glyph_row *end = row + matrix->rows_allocated; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
666 |
25012 | 667 while (row < end) |
668 { | |
669 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
670 = (struct glyph *) xrealloc (row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA], | |
671 (dim.width | |
672 * sizeof (struct glyph))); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
673 |
25012 | 674 /* The mode line never has marginal areas. */ |
675 if (row == matrix->rows + dim.height - 1 | |
25546 | 676 || (row == matrix->rows && matrix->header_line_p)) |
25012 | 677 { |
678 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
679 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
680 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
681 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width; | |
682 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
683 = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
684 } | |
685 else | |
686 { | |
687 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
688 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; | |
689 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] | |
690 = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + dim.width - left - right; | |
691 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] | |
692 = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + dim.width; | |
693 } | |
694 ++row; | |
695 } | |
696 } | |
697 | |
698 xassert (left >= 0 && right >= 0); | |
699 matrix->left_margin_glyphs = left; | |
700 matrix->right_margin_glyphs = right; | |
701 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
702 |
25012 | 703 /* Number of rows to be used by MATRIX. */ |
704 matrix->nrows = dim.height; | |
31932
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
705 xassert (matrix->nrows >= 0); |
25012 | 706 |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
707 if (w) |
25012 | 708 { |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
709 if (matrix == w->current_matrix) |
25012 | 710 { |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
711 /* Mark rows in a current matrix of a window as not having |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
712 valid contents. It's important to not do this for |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
713 desired matrices. When Emacs starts, it may already be |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
714 building desired matrices when this function runs. */ |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
715 if (window_width < 0) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
716 window_width = window_box_width (w, -1); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
717 |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
718 /* Optimize the case that only the height has changed (C-x 2, |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
719 upper window). Invalidate all rows that are no longer part |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
720 of the window. */ |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
721 if (!marginal_areas_changed_p |
37098
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
722 && !header_line_changed_p |
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
723 && new_rows == 0 |
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
724 && dim.width == matrix->matrix_w |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
725 && matrix->window_left_col == WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_COL (w) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
726 && matrix->window_top_line == WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) |
37098
e293840c7332
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Don't try to reuse the current
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36697
diff
changeset
|
727 && matrix->window_width == window_width) |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
728 { |
38528
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
729 /* Find the last row in the window. */ |
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
730 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows && matrix->rows[i].enabled_p; ++i) |
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
731 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (matrix->rows + i) >= window_height) |
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
732 { |
38748
bb32ae33769e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Undo last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38734
diff
changeset
|
733 ++i; |
38528
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
734 break; |
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
735 } |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
736 |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
737 /* Window end is invalid, if inside of the rows that |
38528
c867615c6a26
(adjust_glyph_matrix): In the optimization for
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38489
diff
changeset
|
738 are invalidated below. */ |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
739 if (INTEGERP (w->window_end_vpos) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
740 && XFASTINT (w->window_end_vpos) >= i) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
741 w->window_end_valid = Qnil; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
742 |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
743 while (i < matrix->nrows) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
744 matrix->rows[i++].enabled_p = 0; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
745 } |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
746 else |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
747 { |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
748 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
749 matrix->rows[i].enabled_p = 0; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
750 } |
25012 | 751 } |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
752 else if (matrix == w->desired_matrix) |
25012 | 753 { |
35609
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
754 /* Rows in desired matrices always have to be cleared; |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
755 redisplay expects this is the case when it runs, so it |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
756 had better be the case when we adjust matrices between |
83f1f7fbe26e
(adjust_glyph_matrix): Always clear desired matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35445
diff
changeset
|
757 redisplays. */ |
25012 | 758 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
759 matrix->rows[i].enabled_p = 0; | |
760 } | |
761 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
762 |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
763 |
25012 | 764 /* Remember last values to be able to optimize frame redraws. */ |
765 matrix->matrix_x = x; | |
766 matrix->matrix_y = y; | |
767 matrix->matrix_w = dim.width; | |
768 matrix->matrix_h = dim.height; | |
769 | |
770 /* Record the top y location and height of W at the time the matrix | |
771 was last adjusted. This is used to optimize redisplay above. */ | |
772 if (w) | |
773 { | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
774 matrix->window_left_col = WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_COL (w); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
775 matrix->window_top_line = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w); |
25012 | 776 matrix->window_height = window_height; |
777 matrix->window_width = window_width; | |
778 matrix->window_vscroll = w->vscroll; | |
779 } | |
780 } | |
781 | |
782 | |
783 /* Reverse the contents of rows in MATRIX between START and END. The | |
784 contents of the row at END - 1 end up at START, END - 2 at START + | |
785 1 etc. This is part of the implementation of rotate_matrix (see | |
786 below). */ | |
314 | 787 |
788 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
789 reverse_rows (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int start, int end) |
314 | 790 { |
25012 | 791 int i, j; |
792 | |
793 for (i = start, j = end - 1; i < j; ++i, --j) | |
794 { | |
795 /* Non-ISO HP/UX compiler doesn't like auto struct | |
796 initialization. */ | |
797 struct glyph_row temp; | |
798 temp = matrix->rows[i]; | |
799 matrix->rows[i] = matrix->rows[j]; | |
800 matrix->rows[j] = temp; | |
801 } | |
314 | 802 } |
803 | |
25012 | 804 |
805 /* Rotate the contents of rows in MATRIX in the range FIRST .. LAST - | |
806 1 by BY positions. BY < 0 means rotate left, i.e. towards lower | |
807 indices. (Note: this does not copy glyphs, only glyph pointers in | |
808 row structures are moved around). | |
809 | |
810 The algorithm used for rotating the vector was, I believe, first | |
811 described by Kernighan. See the vector R as consisting of two | |
812 sub-vectors AB, where A has length BY for BY >= 0. The result | |
813 after rotating is then BA. Reverse both sub-vectors to get ArBr | |
814 and reverse the result to get (ArBr)r which is BA. Similar for | |
815 rotating right. */ | |
816 | |
817 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
818 rotate_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int first, int last, int by) |
314 | 819 { |
25012 | 820 if (by < 0) |
821 { | |
822 /* Up (rotate left, i.e. towards lower indices). */ | |
823 by = -by; | |
824 reverse_rows (matrix, first, first + by); | |
825 reverse_rows (matrix, first + by, last); | |
826 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last); | |
827 } | |
828 else if (by > 0) | |
314 | 829 { |
25012 | 830 /* Down (rotate right, i.e. towards higher indices). */ |
831 reverse_rows (matrix, last - by, last); | |
832 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last - by); | |
833 reverse_rows (matrix, first, last); | |
314 | 834 } |
25012 | 835 } |
836 | |
837 | |
838 /* Increment buffer positions in glyph rows of MATRIX. Do it for rows | |
839 with indices START <= index < END. Increment positions by DELTA/ | |
840 DELTA_BYTES. */ | |
841 | |
842 void | |
110552
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
843 increment_matrix_positions (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int start, int end, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
844 EMACS_INT delta, EMACS_INT delta_bytes) |
25012 | 845 { |
846 /* Check that START and END are reasonable values. */ | |
847 xassert (start >= 0 && start <= matrix->nrows); | |
848 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); | |
849 xassert (start <= end); | |
850 | |
851 for (; start < end; ++start) | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
852 increment_row_positions (matrix->rows + start, delta, delta_bytes); |
25012 | 853 } |
854 | |
855 | |
856 /* Enable a range of rows in glyph matrix MATRIX. START and END are | |
857 the row indices of the first and last + 1 row to enable. If | |
858 ENABLED_P is non-zero, enabled_p flags in rows will be set to 1. */ | |
859 | |
860 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
861 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int start, int end, int enabled_p) |
25012 | 862 { |
31932
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
863 xassert (start <= end); |
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
864 xassert (start >= 0 && start < matrix->nrows); |
081edde76197
(adjust_glyph_matrix, enable_glyph_matrix_rows):
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31850
diff
changeset
|
865 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
866 |
25012 | 867 for (; start < end; ++start) |
868 matrix->rows[start].enabled_p = enabled_p != 0; | |
869 } | |
870 | |
871 | |
872 /* Clear MATRIX. | |
873 | |
874 This empties all rows in MATRIX by setting the enabled_p flag for | |
875 all rows of the matrix to zero. The function prepare_desired_row | |
876 will eventually really clear a row when it sees one with a zero | |
877 enabled_p flag. | |
878 | |
879 Resets update hints to defaults value. The only update hint | |
880 currently present is the flag MATRIX->no_scrolling_p. */ | |
881 | |
882 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
883 clear_glyph_matrix (struct glyph_matrix *matrix) |
25012 | 884 { |
885 if (matrix) | |
314 | 886 { |
25012 | 887 enable_glyph_matrix_rows (matrix, 0, matrix->nrows, 0); |
888 matrix->no_scrolling_p = 0; | |
314 | 889 } |
890 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
891 |
25012 | 892 |
893 /* Shift part of the glyph matrix MATRIX of window W up or down. | |
894 Increment y-positions in glyph rows between START and END by DY, | |
895 and recompute their visible height. */ | |
896 | |
897 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
898 shift_glyph_matrix (struct window *w, struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int start, int end, int dy) |
25012 | 899 { |
900 int min_y, max_y; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
901 |
25012 | 902 xassert (start <= end); |
903 xassert (start >= 0 && start < matrix->nrows); | |
904 xassert (end >= 0 && end <= matrix->nrows); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
905 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
906 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
907 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (w); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
908 |
25012 | 909 for (; start < end; ++start) |
910 { | |
911 struct glyph_row *row = &matrix->rows[start]; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
912 |
25012 | 913 row->y += dy; |
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
914 row->visible_height = row->height; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
915 |
25012 | 916 if (row->y < min_y) |
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
917 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y; |
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
918 if (row->y + row->height > max_y) |
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
919 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y; |
25012 | 920 } |
921 } | |
922 | |
923 | |
924 /* Mark all rows in current matrices of frame F as invalid. Marking | |
925 invalid is done by setting enabled_p to zero for all rows in a | |
926 current matrix. */ | |
927 | |
928 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
929 clear_current_matrices (register struct frame *f) |
25012 | 930 { |
931 /* Clear frame current matrix, if we have one. */ | |
932 if (f->current_matrix) | |
933 clear_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix); | |
934 | |
935 /* Clear the matrix of the menu bar window, if such a window exists. | |
936 The menu bar window is currently used to display menus on X when | |
937 no toolkit support is compiled in. */ | |
938 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
939 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window)->current_matrix); | |
940 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
941 /* Clear the matrix of the tool-bar window, if any. */ |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
942 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
943 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->current_matrix); |
25012 | 944 |
945 /* Clear current window matrices. */ | |
946 xassert (WINDOWP (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
947 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 0); | |
948 } | |
949 | |
950 | |
951 /* Clear out all display lines of F for a coming redisplay. */ | |
314 | 952 |
21514 | 953 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
954 clear_desired_matrices (register struct frame *f) |
314 | 955 { |
25012 | 956 if (f->desired_matrix) |
957 clear_glyph_matrix (f->desired_matrix); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
958 |
25012 | 959 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) |
960 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window)->desired_matrix); | |
961 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
962 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
963 clear_glyph_matrix (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->desired_matrix); |
25012 | 964 |
965 /* Do it for window matrices. */ | |
966 xassert (WINDOWP (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
967 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 1); | |
968 } | |
969 | |
970 | |
971 /* Clear matrices in window tree rooted in W. If DESIRED_P is | |
972 non-zero clear desired matrices, otherwise clear current matrices. */ | |
973 | |
974 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
975 clear_window_matrices (struct window *w, int desired_p) |
25012 | 976 { |
977 while (w) | |
314 | 978 { |
25012 | 979 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
980 { | |
981 xassert (WINDOWP (w->hchild)); | |
982 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->hchild), desired_p); | |
983 } | |
984 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
314 | 985 { |
25012 | 986 xassert (WINDOWP (w->vchild)); |
987 clear_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->vchild), desired_p); | |
988 } | |
989 else | |
990 { | |
991 if (desired_p) | |
992 clear_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
993 else | |
314 | 994 { |
25012 | 995 clear_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); |
996 w->window_end_valid = Qnil; | |
314 | 997 } |
25012 | 998 } |
999 | |
1000 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
1001 } | |
1002 } | |
1003 | |
1004 | |
1005 | |
1006 /*********************************************************************** | |
1007 Glyph Rows | |
1008 | |
1009 See dispextern.h for an overall explanation of glyph rows. | |
1010 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1011 | |
1012 /* Clear glyph row ROW. Do it in a way that makes it robust against | |
1013 changes in the glyph_row structure, i.e. addition or removal of | |
1014 structure members. */ | |
1015 | |
33527
c4c7abc48752
(null_row): New gloval static variable.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
33101
diff
changeset
|
1016 static struct glyph_row null_row; |
c4c7abc48752
(null_row): New gloval static variable.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
33101
diff
changeset
|
1017 |
25012 | 1018 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1019 clear_glyph_row (struct glyph_row *row) |
25012 | 1020 { |
1021 struct glyph *p[1 + LAST_AREA]; | |
1022 | |
1023 /* Save pointers. */ | |
1024 p[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1025 p[TEXT_AREA] = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1026 p[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1027 p[LAST_AREA] = row->glyphs[LAST_AREA]; | |
1028 | |
1029 /* Clear. */ | |
1030 *row = null_row; | |
1031 | |
1032 /* Restore pointers. */ | |
1033 row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = p[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1034 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = p[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1035 row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = p[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]; | |
1036 row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] = p[LAST_AREA]; | |
30041
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1037 |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1038 #if 0 /* At some point, some bit-fields of struct glyph were not set, |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1039 which made glyphs unequal when compared with GLYPH_EQUAL_P. |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1040 Redisplay outputs such glyphs, and flickering effects were |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1041 the result. This also depended on the contents of memory |
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1042 returned by xmalloc. If flickering happens again, activate |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1043 the code below. If the flickering is gone with that, chances |
30041
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1044 are that the flickering has the same reason as here. */ |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1045 memset (p[0], 0, (char *) p[LAST_AREA] - (char *) p[0]); |
30041
b20d72b7aa4b
(clear_glyph_row): Add debug code in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29980
diff
changeset
|
1046 #endif |
25012 | 1047 } |
1048 | |
1049 | |
1050 /* Make ROW an empty, enabled row of canonical character height, | |
1051 in window W starting at y-position Y. */ | |
1052 | |
1053 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1054 blank_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int y) |
25012 | 1055 { |
1056 int min_y, max_y; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1057 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
1058 min_y = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
1059 max_y = WINDOW_BOX_HEIGHT_NO_MODE_LINE (w); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1060 |
25012 | 1061 clear_glyph_row (row); |
1062 row->y = y; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1063 row->ascent = row->phys_ascent = 0; |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
1064 row->height = row->phys_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (XFRAME (w->frame)); |
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1065 row->visible_height = row->height; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1066 |
25012 | 1067 if (row->y < min_y) |
38587
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1068 row->visible_height -= min_y - row->y; |
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1069 if (row->y + row->height > max_y) |
42e75caf68ff
(shift_glyph_matrix, blank_row): Fix computation
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38528
diff
changeset
|
1070 row->visible_height -= row->y + row->height - max_y; |
25012 | 1071 |
1072 row->enabled_p = 1; | |
1073 } | |
1074 | |
1075 | |
1076 /* Increment buffer positions in glyph row ROW. DELTA and DELTA_BYTES | |
1077 are the amounts by which to change positions. Note that the first | |
1078 glyph of the text area of a row can have a buffer position even if | |
1079 the used count of the text area is zero. Such rows display line | |
1080 ends. */ | |
1081 | |
1082 void | |
110552
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
1083 increment_row_positions (struct glyph_row *row, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
1084 EMACS_INT delta, EMACS_INT delta_bytes) |
25012 | 1085 { |
1086 int area, i; | |
1087 | |
1088 /* Increment start and end positions. */ | |
1089 MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row) += delta; | |
1090 MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) += delta_bytes; | |
1091 MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) += delta; | |
1092 MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) += delta_bytes; | |
108656
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1093 CHARPOS (row->start.pos) += delta; |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1094 BYTEPOS (row->start.pos) += delta_bytes; |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1095 CHARPOS (row->end.pos) += delta; |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1096 BYTEPOS (row->end.pos) += delta_bytes; |
25012 | 1097 |
65003
74ab28cf1192
(increment_row_positions): Skip non-enabled rows.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
64776
diff
changeset
|
1098 if (!row->enabled_p) |
74ab28cf1192
(increment_row_positions): Skip non-enabled rows.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
64776
diff
changeset
|
1099 return; |
74ab28cf1192
(increment_row_positions): Skip non-enabled rows.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
64776
diff
changeset
|
1100 |
25012 | 1101 /* Increment positions in glyphs. */ |
1102 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1103 for (i = 0; i < row->used[area]; ++i) | |
1104 if (BUFFERP (row->glyphs[area][i].object) | |
1105 && row->glyphs[area][i].charpos > 0) | |
1106 row->glyphs[area][i].charpos += delta; | |
1107 | |
1108 /* Capture the case of rows displaying a line end. */ | |
1109 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA] == 0 | |
1110 && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)) | |
1111 row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]->charpos += delta; | |
1112 } | |
1113 | |
1114 | |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1115 #if 0 |
25012 | 1116 /* Swap glyphs between two glyph rows A and B. This exchanges glyph |
1117 contents, i.e. glyph structure contents are exchanged between A and | |
1118 B without changing glyph pointers in A and B. */ | |
1119 | |
1120 static void | |
1121 swap_glyphs_in_rows (a, b) | |
1122 struct glyph_row *a, *b; | |
1123 { | |
1124 int area; | |
1125 | |
1126 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1127 { | |
1128 /* Number of glyphs to swap. */ | |
1129 int max_used = max (a->used[area], b->used[area]); | |
1130 | |
1131 /* Start of glyphs in area of row A. */ | |
1132 struct glyph *glyph_a = a->glyphs[area]; | |
1133 | |
1134 /* End + 1 of glyphs in area of row A. */ | |
1135 struct glyph *glyph_a_end = a->glyphs[max_used]; | |
1136 | |
1137 /* Start of glyphs in area of row B. */ | |
1138 struct glyph *glyph_b = b->glyphs[area]; | |
1139 | |
1140 while (glyph_a < glyph_a_end) | |
1141 { | |
1142 /* Non-ISO HP/UX compiler doesn't like auto struct | |
1143 initialization. */ | |
1144 struct glyph temp; | |
1145 temp = *glyph_a; | |
1146 *glyph_a = *glyph_b; | |
1147 *glyph_b = temp; | |
1148 ++glyph_a; | |
1149 ++glyph_b; | |
314 | 1150 } |
1151 } | |
1152 } | |
25012 | 1153 |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1154 #endif /* 0 */ |
25012 | 1155 |
1156 /* Exchange pointers to glyph memory between glyph rows A and B. */ | |
1157 | |
1158 static INLINE void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1159 swap_glyph_pointers (struct glyph_row *a, struct glyph_row *b) |
25012 | 1160 { |
1161 int i; | |
1162 for (i = 0; i < LAST_AREA + 1; ++i) | |
1163 { | |
1164 struct glyph *temp = a->glyphs[i]; | |
1165 a->glyphs[i] = b->glyphs[i]; | |
1166 b->glyphs[i] = temp; | |
1167 } | |
1168 } | |
1169 | |
1170 | |
1171 /* Copy glyph row structure FROM to glyph row structure TO, except | |
1172 that glyph pointers in the structures are left unchanged. */ | |
1173 | |
111640
8bd4a845ba2a
* src/xfaces.c (lookup_face): Make static.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
111566
diff
changeset
|
1174 static INLINE void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1175 copy_row_except_pointers (struct glyph_row *to, struct glyph_row *from) |
25012 | 1176 { |
1177 struct glyph *pointers[1 + LAST_AREA]; | |
1178 | |
1179 /* Save glyph pointers of TO. */ | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1180 memcpy (pointers, to->glyphs, sizeof to->glyphs); |
25012 | 1181 |
1182 /* Do a structure assignment. */ | |
1183 *to = *from; | |
1184 | |
1185 /* Restore original pointers of TO. */ | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1186 memcpy (to->glyphs, pointers, sizeof to->glyphs); |
25012 | 1187 } |
1188 | |
1189 | |
1190 /* Copy contents of glyph row FROM to glyph row TO. Glyph pointers in | |
1191 TO and FROM are left unchanged. Glyph contents are copied from the | |
1192 glyph memory of FROM to the glyph memory of TO. Increment buffer | |
1193 positions in row TO by DELTA/ DELTA_BYTES. */ | |
1194 | |
1195 void | |
110552
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
1196 copy_glyph_row_contents (struct glyph_row *to, struct glyph_row *from, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
1197 EMACS_INT delta, EMACS_INT delta_bytes) |
25012 | 1198 { |
1199 int area; | |
1200 | |
1201 /* This is like a structure assignment TO = FROM, except that | |
1202 glyph pointers in the rows are left unchanged. */ | |
1203 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from); | |
1204 | |
1205 /* Copy glyphs from FROM to TO. */ | |
1206 for (area = 0; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1207 if (from->used[area]) | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1208 memcpy (to->glyphs[area], from->glyphs[area], |
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1209 from->used[area] * sizeof (struct glyph)); |
25012 | 1210 |
1211 /* Increment buffer positions in TO by DELTA. */ | |
28708
4e2497e6757e
(increment_matrix_positions): Renamed from
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28682
diff
changeset
|
1212 increment_row_positions (to, delta, delta_bytes); |
25012 | 1213 } |
1214 | |
1215 | |
1216 /* Assign glyph row FROM to glyph row TO. This works like a structure | |
1217 assignment TO = FROM, except that glyph pointers are not copied but | |
1218 exchanged between TO and FROM. Pointers must be exchanged to avoid | |
1219 a memory leak. */ | |
1220 | |
1221 static INLINE void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1222 assign_row (struct glyph_row *to, struct glyph_row *from) |
25012 | 1223 { |
1224 swap_glyph_pointers (to, from); | |
1225 copy_row_except_pointers (to, from); | |
1226 } | |
1227 | |
1228 | |
1229 /* Test whether the glyph memory of the glyph row WINDOW_ROW, which is | |
1230 a row in a window matrix, is a slice of the glyph memory of the | |
1231 glyph row FRAME_ROW which is a row in a frame glyph matrix. Value | |
1232 is non-zero if the glyph memory of WINDOW_ROW is part of the glyph | |
1233 memory of FRAME_ROW. */ | |
1234 | |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
1235 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
1236 |
25012 | 1237 static int |
112021 | 1238 glyph_row_slice_p (struct glyph_row *window_row, struct glyph_row *frame_row) |
25012 | 1239 { |
1240 struct glyph *window_glyph_start = window_row->glyphs[0]; | |
1241 struct glyph *frame_glyph_start = frame_row->glyphs[0]; | |
1242 struct glyph *frame_glyph_end = frame_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA]; | |
1243 | |
1244 return (frame_glyph_start <= window_glyph_start | |
1245 && window_glyph_start < frame_glyph_end); | |
1246 } | |
1247 | |
30323
4cd1b8fe118c
(direct_output_for_insert): Remove confusing
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30307
diff
changeset
|
1248 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
25012 | 1249 |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1250 #if 0 |
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1251 |
25012 | 1252 /* Find the row in the window glyph matrix WINDOW_MATRIX being a slice |
1253 of ROW in the frame matrix FRAME_MATRIX. Value is null if no row | |
1254 in WINDOW_MATRIX is found satisfying the condition. */ | |
1255 | |
1256 static struct glyph_row * | |
112021 | 1257 find_glyph_row_slice (struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix, |
1258 struct glyph_matrix *frame_matrix, int row) | |
25012 | 1259 { |
1260 int i; | |
1261 | |
1262 xassert (row >= 0 && row < frame_matrix->nrows); | |
1263 | |
1264 for (i = 0; i < window_matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
1265 if (glyph_row_slice_p (window_matrix->rows + i, | |
1266 frame_matrix->rows + row)) | |
1267 break; | |
1268 | |
1269 return i < window_matrix->nrows ? window_matrix->rows + i : 0; | |
1270 } | |
1271 | |
29336
5ccfe8a1638f
(find_glyph_row_slice, swap_glyphs_in_rows): Put in #if 0.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28708
diff
changeset
|
1272 #endif /* 0 */ |
25012 | 1273 |
1274 /* Prepare ROW for display. Desired rows are cleared lazily, | |
1275 i.e. they are only marked as to be cleared by setting their | |
1276 enabled_p flag to zero. When a row is to be displayed, a prior | |
1277 call to this function really clears it. */ | |
1278 | |
1279 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1280 prepare_desired_row (struct glyph_row *row) |
25012 | 1281 { |
1282 if (!row->enabled_p) | |
1283 { | |
107624
552007beee69
Finish and debug display of invisible text.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107617
diff
changeset
|
1284 unsigned rp = row->reversed_p; |
552007beee69
Finish and debug display of invisible text.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107617
diff
changeset
|
1285 |
25012 | 1286 clear_glyph_row (row); |
1287 row->enabled_p = 1; | |
107624
552007beee69
Finish and debug display of invisible text.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107617
diff
changeset
|
1288 row->reversed_p = rp; |
25012 | 1289 } |
1290 } | |
1291 | |
1292 | |
1293 /* Return a hash code for glyph row ROW. */ | |
1294 | |
112023
ac49e05bfcf2
Remove unused declarations
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
112021
diff
changeset
|
1295 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1296 line_hash_code (struct glyph_row *row) |
25012 | 1297 { |
1298 int hash = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1299 |
25012 | 1300 if (row->enabled_p) |
1301 { | |
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1302 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1303 struct glyph *end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1304 |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1305 while (glyph < end) |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1306 { |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1307 int c = glyph->u.ch; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1308 int face_id = glyph->face_id; |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
1309 if (FRAME_MUST_WRITE_SPACES (SELECTED_FRAME ())) /* XXX Is SELECTED_FRAME OK here? */ |
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1310 c -= SPACEGLYPH; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1311 hash = (((hash << 4) + (hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff) + c; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1312 hash = (((hash << 4) + (hash >> 24)) & 0x0fffffff) + face_id; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1313 ++glyph; |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1314 } |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1315 |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1316 if (hash == 0) |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
1317 hash = 1; |
25012 | 1318 } |
1319 | |
1320 return hash; | |
1321 } | |
1322 | |
1323 | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1324 /* Return the cost of drawing line VPOS in MATRIX. The cost equals |
25012 | 1325 the number of characters in the line. If must_write_spaces is |
1326 zero, leading and trailing spaces are ignored. */ | |
1327 | |
1328 static unsigned int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1329 line_draw_cost (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int vpos) |
25012 | 1330 { |
1331 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows + vpos; | |
1332 struct glyph *beg = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1333 struct glyph *end = beg + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
1334 int len; | |
1335 Lisp_Object *glyph_table_base = GLYPH_TABLE_BASE; | |
1336 int glyph_table_len = GLYPH_TABLE_LENGTH; | |
1337 | |
1338 /* Ignore trailing and leading spaces if we can. */ | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
1339 if (!FRAME_MUST_WRITE_SPACES (SELECTED_FRAME ())) /* XXX Is SELECTED_FRAME OK here? */ |
25012 | 1340 { |
1341 /* Skip from the end over trailing spaces. */ | |
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
1342 while (end > beg && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (*(end - 1))) |
25012 | 1343 --end; |
1344 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1345 /* All blank line. */ |
25012 | 1346 if (end == beg) |
1347 return 0; | |
1348 | |
1349 /* Skip over leading spaces. */ | |
1350 while (CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (*beg)) | |
1351 ++beg; | |
1352 } | |
1353 | |
1354 /* If we don't have a glyph-table, each glyph is one character, | |
1355 so return the number of glyphs. */ | |
1356 if (glyph_table_base == 0) | |
1357 len = end - beg; | |
1358 else | |
1359 { | |
1360 /* Otherwise, scan the glyphs and accumulate their total length | |
1361 in LEN. */ | |
1362 len = 0; | |
1363 while (beg < end) | |
1364 { | |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
1365 GLYPH g; |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
1366 |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
1367 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR_GLYPH (g, *beg); |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
1368 |
92387
41d029d73eac
(line_draw_cost): Fix invalid glyph check.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
92276
diff
changeset
|
1369 if (GLYPH_INVALID_P (g) |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
1370 || GLYPH_SIMPLE_P (glyph_table_base, glyph_table_len, g)) |
25012 | 1371 len += 1; |
1372 else | |
1373 len += GLYPH_LENGTH (glyph_table_base, g); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1374 |
25012 | 1375 ++beg; |
1376 } | |
1377 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1378 |
25012 | 1379 return len; |
1380 } | |
1381 | |
1382 | |
1383 /* Test two glyph rows A and B for equality. Value is non-zero if A | |
1384 and B have equal contents. W is the window to which the glyphs | |
1385 rows A and B belong. It is needed here to test for partial row | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1386 visibility. MOUSE_FACE_P non-zero means compare the mouse_face_p |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1387 flags of A and B, too. */ |
25012 | 1388 |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1389 static INLINE int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1390 row_equal_p (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *a, struct glyph_row *b, int mouse_face_p) |
25012 | 1391 { |
1392 if (a == b) | |
1393 return 1; | |
1394 else if (a->hash != b->hash) | |
1395 return 0; | |
1396 else | |
1397 { | |
1398 struct glyph *a_glyph, *b_glyph, *a_end; | |
1399 int area; | |
1400 | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1401 if (mouse_face_p && a->mouse_face_p != b->mouse_face_p) |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1402 return 0; |
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
1403 |
25012 | 1404 /* Compare glyphs. */ |
1405 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) | |
1406 { | |
1407 if (a->used[area] != b->used[area]) | |
1408 return 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1409 |
25012 | 1410 a_glyph = a->glyphs[area]; |
1411 a_end = a_glyph + a->used[area]; | |
1412 b_glyph = b->glyphs[area]; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1413 |
25012 | 1414 while (a_glyph < a_end |
1415 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (a_glyph, b_glyph)) | |
1416 ++a_glyph, ++b_glyph; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1417 |
25012 | 1418 if (a_glyph != a_end) |
1419 return 0; | |
1420 } | |
1421 | |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
1422 if (a->fill_line_p != b->fill_line_p |
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
1423 || a->cursor_in_fringe_p != b->cursor_in_fringe_p |
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
1424 || a->left_fringe_bitmap != b->left_fringe_bitmap |
53881
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
1425 || a->left_fringe_face_id != b->left_fringe_face_id |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
1426 || a->right_fringe_bitmap != b->right_fringe_bitmap |
53881
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
1427 || a->right_fringe_face_id != b->right_fringe_face_id |
61633
a76a30ee7c89
(row_equal_p, update_window_line, scrolling_window):
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
61416
diff
changeset
|
1428 || a->overlay_arrow_bitmap != b->overlay_arrow_bitmap |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
1429 || a->exact_window_width_line_p != b->exact_window_width_line_p |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1430 || a->overlapped_p != b->overlapped_p |
25012 | 1431 || (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (a) |
1432 != MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (b)) | |
107636
b5cb7368c1bc
Continue work on continuation lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107624
diff
changeset
|
1433 || a->reversed_p != b->reversed_p |
25012 | 1434 /* Different partially visible characters on left margin. */ |
1435 || a->x != b->x | |
1436 /* Different height. */ | |
1437 || a->ascent != b->ascent | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1438 || a->phys_ascent != b->phys_ascent |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1439 || a->phys_height != b->phys_height |
25012 | 1440 || a->visible_height != b->visible_height) |
1441 return 0; | |
1442 } | |
1443 | |
1444 return 1; | |
1445 } | |
1446 | |
1447 | |
314 | 1448 |
25012 | 1449 /*********************************************************************** |
1450 Glyph Pool | |
1451 | |
1452 See dispextern.h for an overall explanation of glyph pools. | |
1453 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1454 | |
1455 /* Allocate a glyph_pool structure. The structure returned is | |
1456 initialized with zeros. The global variable glyph_pool_count is | |
1457 incremented for each pool allocated. */ | |
1458 | |
1459 static struct glyph_pool * | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1460 new_glyph_pool (void) |
25012 | 1461 { |
1462 struct glyph_pool *result; | |
1463 | |
1464 /* Allocate a new glyph_pool and clear it. */ | |
1465 result = (struct glyph_pool *) xmalloc (sizeof *result); | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1466 memset (result, 0, sizeof *result); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1467 |
25012 | 1468 /* For memory leak and double deletion checking. */ |
1469 ++glyph_pool_count; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1470 |
25012 | 1471 return result; |
1472 } | |
1473 | |
1474 | |
1475 /* Free a glyph_pool structure POOL. The function may be called with | |
1476 a null POOL pointer. The global variable glyph_pool_count is | |
1477 decremented with every pool structure freed. If this count gets | |
1478 negative, more structures were freed than allocated, i.e. one | |
1479 structure must have been freed more than once or a bogus pointer | |
1480 was passed to free_glyph_pool. */ | |
1481 | |
1482 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1483 free_glyph_pool (struct glyph_pool *pool) |
25012 | 1484 { |
1485 if (pool) | |
1486 { | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1487 /* More freed than allocated? */ |
25012 | 1488 --glyph_pool_count; |
1489 xassert (glyph_pool_count >= 0); | |
1490 | |
1491 xfree (pool->glyphs); | |
1492 xfree (pool); | |
1493 } | |
1494 } | |
1495 | |
1496 | |
1497 /* Enlarge a glyph pool POOL. MATRIX_DIM gives the number of rows and | |
1498 columns we need. This function never shrinks a pool. The only | |
1499 case in which this would make sense, would be when a frame's size | |
1500 is changed from a large value to a smaller one. But, if someone | |
1501 does it once, we can expect that he will do it again. | |
1502 | |
1503 Value is non-zero if the pool changed in a way which makes | |
1504 re-adjusting window glyph matrices necessary. */ | |
1505 | |
1506 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1507 realloc_glyph_pool (struct glyph_pool *pool, struct dim matrix_dim) |
25012 | 1508 { |
1509 int needed; | |
1510 int changed_p; | |
1511 | |
1512 changed_p = (pool->glyphs == 0 | |
1513 || matrix_dim.height != pool->nrows | |
1514 || matrix_dim.width != pool->ncolumns); | |
1515 | |
1516 /* Enlarge the glyph pool. */ | |
1517 needed = matrix_dim.width * matrix_dim.height; | |
1518 if (needed > pool->nglyphs) | |
1519 { | |
1520 int size = needed * sizeof (struct glyph); | |
1521 | |
1522 if (pool->glyphs) | |
109660
85236524c2a3
Fix redisplay bugs due to uninitialized glyphs in frame glyph pool.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109573
diff
changeset
|
1523 { |
85236524c2a3
Fix redisplay bugs due to uninitialized glyphs in frame glyph pool.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109573
diff
changeset
|
1524 pool->glyphs = (struct glyph *) xrealloc (pool->glyphs, size); |
85236524c2a3
Fix redisplay bugs due to uninitialized glyphs in frame glyph pool.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109573
diff
changeset
|
1525 memset (pool->glyphs + pool->nglyphs, 0, |
85236524c2a3
Fix redisplay bugs due to uninitialized glyphs in frame glyph pool.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109573
diff
changeset
|
1526 size - pool->nglyphs * sizeof (struct glyph)); |
85236524c2a3
Fix redisplay bugs due to uninitialized glyphs in frame glyph pool.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109573
diff
changeset
|
1527 } |
25012 | 1528 else |
1529 { | |
1530 pool->glyphs = (struct glyph *) xmalloc (size); | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1531 memset (pool->glyphs, 0, size); |
25012 | 1532 } |
1533 | |
1534 pool->nglyphs = needed; | |
1535 } | |
1536 | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1537 /* Remember the number of rows and columns because (a) we use them |
25012 | 1538 to do sanity checks, and (b) the number of columns determines |
1539 where rows in the frame matrix start---this must be available to | |
1540 determine pointers to rows of window sub-matrices. */ | |
1541 pool->nrows = matrix_dim.height; | |
1542 pool->ncolumns = matrix_dim.width; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1543 |
25012 | 1544 return changed_p; |
1545 } | |
1546 | |
1547 | |
1548 | |
1549 /*********************************************************************** | |
1550 Debug Code | |
1551 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1552 | |
1553 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
1554 | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1555 |
53226
dd3018b4785b
Implemented multiple tty support.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53225
diff
changeset
|
1556 /* Flush standard output. This is sometimes useful to call from the debugger. |
dd3018b4785b
Implemented multiple tty support.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53225
diff
changeset
|
1557 XXX Maybe this should be changed to flush the current terminal instead of |
dd3018b4785b
Implemented multiple tty support.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53225
diff
changeset
|
1558 stdout. |
dd3018b4785b
Implemented multiple tty support.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53225
diff
changeset
|
1559 */ |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1560 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1561 void |
112021 | 1562 flush_stdout (void) |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1563 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1564 fflush (stdout); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1565 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1566 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
1567 |
25012 | 1568 /* Check that no glyph pointers have been lost in MATRIX. If a |
1569 pointer has been lost, e.g. by using a structure assignment between | |
1570 rows, at least one pointer must occur more than once in the rows of | |
1571 MATRIX. */ | |
1572 | |
1573 void | |
112021 | 1574 check_matrix_pointer_lossage (struct glyph_matrix *matrix) |
25012 | 1575 { |
1576 int i, j; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1577 |
25012 | 1578 for (i = 0; i < matrix->nrows; ++i) |
1579 for (j = 0; j < matrix->nrows; ++j) | |
1580 xassert (i == j | |
1581 || (matrix->rows[i].glyphs[TEXT_AREA] | |
1582 != matrix->rows[j].glyphs[TEXT_AREA])); | |
1583 } | |
1584 | |
1585 | |
1586 /* Get a pointer to glyph row ROW in MATRIX, with bounds checks. */ | |
1587 | |
1588 struct glyph_row * | |
112021 | 1589 matrix_row (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int row) |
25012 | 1590 { |
1591 xassert (matrix && matrix->rows); | |
1592 xassert (row >= 0 && row < matrix->nrows); | |
1593 | |
1594 /* That's really too slow for normal testing because this function | |
1595 is called almost everywhere. Although---it's still astonishingly | |
1596 fast, so it is valuable to have for debugging purposes. */ | |
314 | 1597 #if 0 |
25012 | 1598 check_matrix_pointer_lossage (matrix); |
1599 #endif | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1600 |
25012 | 1601 return matrix->rows + row; |
1602 } | |
1603 | |
1604 | |
1605 #if 0 /* This function makes invalid assumptions when text is | |
1606 partially invisible. But it might come handy for debugging | |
1607 nevertheless. */ | |
1608 | |
1609 /* Check invariants that must hold for an up to date current matrix of | |
1610 window W. */ | |
1611 | |
1612 static void | |
112021 | 1613 check_matrix_invariants (struct window *w) |
314 | 1614 { |
25012 | 1615 struct glyph_matrix *matrix = w->current_matrix; |
1616 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
1617 struct glyph_row *row = matrix->rows; | |
1618 struct glyph_row *last_text_row = NULL; | |
1619 struct buffer *saved = current_buffer; | |
1620 struct buffer *buffer = XBUFFER (w->buffer); | |
1621 int c; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1622 |
25012 | 1623 /* This can sometimes happen for a fresh window. */ |
1624 if (matrix->nrows < 2) | |
1625 return; | |
1626 | |
1627 set_buffer_temp (buffer); | |
1628 | |
1629 /* Note: last row is always reserved for the mode line. */ | |
1630 while (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row) | |
1631 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) < yb) | |
1632 { | |
1633 struct glyph_row *next = row + 1; | |
1634 | |
1635 if (MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (row)) | |
1636 last_text_row = row; | |
1637 | |
1638 /* Check that character and byte positions are in sync. */ | |
1639 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (row) | |
1640 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (row))); | |
108656
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1641 xassert (BYTEPOS (row->start.pos) |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1642 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (row->start.pos))); |
25012 | 1643 |
1644 /* CHAR_TO_BYTE aborts when invoked for a position > Z. We can | |
1645 have such a position temporarily in case of a minibuffer | |
1646 displaying something like `[Sole completion]' at its end. */ | |
1647 if (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) < BUF_ZV (current_buffer)) | |
108656
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1648 { |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1649 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1650 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row))); |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1651 xassert (BYTEPOS (row->end.pos) |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1652 == CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (row->end.pos))); |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1653 } |
25012 | 1654 |
1655 /* Check that end position of `row' is equal to start position | |
1656 of next row. */ | |
1657 if (next->enabled_p && MATRIX_ROW_DISPLAYS_TEXT_P (next)) | |
1658 { | |
1659 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_CHARPOS (row) | |
1660 == MATRIX_ROW_START_CHARPOS (next)); | |
1661 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_END_BYTEPOS (row) | |
1662 == MATRIX_ROW_START_BYTEPOS (next)); | |
108656
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1663 xassert (CHARPOS (row->end.pos) == CHARPOS (next->start.pos)); |
0b28d05fa415
Initial reimplementation of calculating line edge positions in bidi lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107991
diff
changeset
|
1664 xassert (BYTEPOS (row->end.pos) == BYTEPOS (next->start.pos)); |
25012 | 1665 } |
1666 row = next; | |
1667 } | |
1668 | |
1669 xassert (w->current_matrix->nrows == w->desired_matrix->nrows); | |
1670 xassert (w->desired_matrix->rows != NULL); | |
1671 set_buffer_temp (saved); | |
1672 } | |
1673 | |
1674 #endif /* 0 */ | |
1675 | |
1676 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */ | |
1677 | |
1678 | |
1679 | |
1680 /********************************************************************** | |
1681 Allocating/ Adjusting Glyph Matrices | |
1682 **********************************************************************/ | |
1683 | |
1684 /* Allocate glyph matrices over a window tree for a frame-based | |
1685 redisplay | |
1686 | |
1687 X and Y are column/row within the frame glyph matrix where | |
1688 sub-matrices for the window tree rooted at WINDOW must be | |
73383
015a870c0c9a
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Remove unused variable ch_dim.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73318
diff
changeset
|
1689 allocated. DIM_ONLY_P non-zero means that the caller of this |
015a870c0c9a
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Remove unused variable ch_dim.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73318
diff
changeset
|
1690 function is only interested in the result matrix dimension, and |
015a870c0c9a
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Remove unused variable ch_dim.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73318
diff
changeset
|
1691 matrix adjustments should not be performed. |
25012 | 1692 |
1693 The function returns the total width/height of the sub-matrices of | |
1694 the window tree. If called on a frame root window, the computation | |
1695 will take the mini-buffer window into account. | |
1696 | |
1697 *WINDOW_CHANGE_FLAGS is set to a bit mask with bits | |
1698 | |
1699 NEW_LEAF_MATRIX set if any window in the tree did not have a | |
1700 glyph matrices yet, and | |
1701 | |
1702 CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX set if the dimension or location of a matrix of | |
1703 any window in the tree will be changed or have been changed (see | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1704 DIM_ONLY_P) |
25012 | 1705 |
1706 *WINDOW_CHANGE_FLAGS must be initialized by the caller of this | |
1707 function. | |
1708 | |
1709 Windows are arranged into chains of windows on the same level | |
1710 through the next fields of window structures. Such a level can be | |
1711 either a sequence of horizontally adjacent windows from left to | |
1712 right, or a sequence of vertically adjacent windows from top to | |
1713 bottom. Each window in a horizontal sequence can be either a leaf | |
1714 window or a vertical sequence; a window in a vertical sequence can | |
1715 be either a leaf or a horizontal sequence. All windows in a | |
1716 horizontal sequence have the same height, and all windows in a | |
1717 vertical sequence have the same width. | |
1718 | |
1719 This function uses, for historical reasons, a more general | |
1720 algorithm to determine glyph matrix dimensions that would be | |
1721 necessary. | |
1722 | |
1723 The matrix height of a horizontal sequence is determined by the | |
1724 maximum height of any matrix in the sequence. The matrix width of | |
1725 a horizontal sequence is computed by adding up matrix widths of | |
1726 windows in the sequence. | |
1727 | |
1728 |<------- result width ------->| | |
1729 +---------+----------+---------+ --- | |
1730 | | | | | | |
1731 | | | | | |
1732 +---------+ | | result height | |
1733 | +---------+ | |
1734 | | | | |
1735 +----------+ --- | |
1736 | |
1737 The matrix width of a vertical sequence is the maximum matrix width | |
1738 of any window in the sequence. Its height is computed by adding up | |
1739 matrix heights of windows in the sequence. | |
1740 | |
1741 |<---- result width -->| | |
1742 +---------+ --- | |
1743 | | | | |
1744 | | | | |
1745 +---------+--+ | | |
1746 | | | | |
1747 | | result height | |
1748 | | | |
1749 +------------+---------+ | | |
1750 | | | | |
1751 | | | | |
1752 +------------+---------+ --- */ | |
1753 | |
1754 /* Bit indicating that a new matrix will be allocated or has been | |
1755 allocated. */ | |
1756 | |
1757 #define NEW_LEAF_MATRIX (1 << 0) | |
1758 | |
1759 /* Bit indicating that a matrix will or has changed its location or | |
1760 size. */ | |
1761 | |
1762 #define CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX (1 << 1) | |
1763 | |
1764 static struct dim | |
109360
f37b85834f7e
Convert more function definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109179
diff
changeset
|
1765 allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (Lisp_Object window, int x, int y, |
f37b85834f7e
Convert more function definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109179
diff
changeset
|
1766 int dim_only_p, int *window_change_flags) |
25012 | 1767 { |
1768 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (window))); | |
1769 int x0 = x, y0 = y; | |
1770 int wmax = 0, hmax = 0; | |
1771 struct dim total; | |
1772 struct dim dim; | |
1773 struct window *w; | |
1774 int in_horz_combination_p; | |
1775 | |
1776 /* What combination is WINDOW part of? Compute this once since the | |
1777 result is the same for all windows in the `next' chain. The | |
1778 special case of a root window (parent equal to nil) is treated | |
1779 like a vertical combination because a root window's `next' | |
1780 points to the mini-buffer window, if any, which is arranged | |
1781 vertically below other windows. */ | |
1782 in_horz_combination_p | |
1783 = (!NILP (XWINDOW (window)->parent) | |
1784 && !NILP (XWINDOW (XWINDOW (window)->parent)->hchild)); | |
1785 | |
1786 /* For WINDOW and all windows on the same level. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1787 do |
25012 | 1788 { |
1789 w = XWINDOW (window); | |
1790 | |
1791 /* Get the dimension of the window sub-matrix for W, depending | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1792 on whether this is a combination or a leaf window. */ |
25012 | 1793 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1794 dim = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (w->hchild, x, y, |
25012 | 1795 dim_only_p, |
1796 window_change_flags); | |
1797 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1798 dim = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (w->vchild, x, y, |
25012 | 1799 dim_only_p, |
1800 window_change_flags); | |
1801 else | |
1802 { | |
1803 /* If not already done, allocate sub-matrix structures. */ | |
1804 if (w->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
1805 { | |
1806 w->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->desired_pool); | |
1807 w->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->current_pool); | |
1808 *window_change_flags |= NEW_LEAF_MATRIX; | |
1809 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1810 |
25012 | 1811 /* Width and height MUST be chosen so that there are no |
1812 holes in the frame matrix. */ | |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1813 dim.width = required_matrix_width (w); |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1814 dim.height = required_matrix_height (w); |
25012 | 1815 |
1816 /* Will matrix be re-allocated? */ | |
1817 if (x != w->desired_matrix->matrix_x | |
1818 || y != w->desired_matrix->matrix_y | |
1819 || dim.width != w->desired_matrix->matrix_w | |
1820 || dim.height != w->desired_matrix->matrix_h | |
1821 || (margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
56496
069e4841ceb2
(margin_glyphs_to_reserve): Apply ncols_scale_factor.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
55021
diff
changeset
|
1822 w->left_margin_cols) |
25012 | 1823 != w->desired_matrix->left_margin_glyphs) |
1824 || (margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, dim.width, | |
56496
069e4841ceb2
(margin_glyphs_to_reserve): Apply ncols_scale_factor.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
55021
diff
changeset
|
1825 w->right_margin_cols) |
25012 | 1826 != w->desired_matrix->right_margin_glyphs)) |
1827 *window_change_flags |= CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX; | |
1828 | |
1829 /* Actually change matrices, if allowed. Do not consider | |
1830 CHANGED_LEAF_MATRIX computed above here because the pool | |
1831 may have been changed which we don't now here. We trust | |
1832 that we only will be called with DIM_ONLY_P != 0 when | |
1833 necessary. */ | |
1834 if (!dim_only_p) | |
1835 { | |
1836 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->desired_matrix, x, y, dim); | |
1837 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->current_matrix, x, y, dim); | |
1838 } | |
1839 } | |
1840 | |
1841 /* If we are part of a horizontal combination, advance x for | |
1842 windows to the right of W; otherwise advance y for windows | |
1843 below W. */ | |
1844 if (in_horz_combination_p) | |
1845 x += dim.width; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1846 else |
25012 | 1847 y += dim.height; |
1848 | |
1849 /* Remember maximum glyph matrix dimensions. */ | |
1850 wmax = max (wmax, dim.width); | |
1851 hmax = max (hmax, dim.height); | |
1852 | |
1853 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
1854 window = w->next; | |
1855 } | |
1856 while (!NILP (window)); | |
1857 | |
1858 /* Set `total' to the total glyph matrix dimension of this window | |
1859 level. In a vertical combination, the width is the width of the | |
1860 widest window; the height is the y we finally reached, corrected | |
1861 by the y we started with. In a horizontal combination, the total | |
1862 height is the height of the tallest window, and the width is the | |
1863 x we finally reached, corrected by the x we started with. */ | |
1864 if (in_horz_combination_p) | |
1865 { | |
1866 total.width = x - x0; | |
1867 total.height = hmax; | |
1868 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1869 else |
25012 | 1870 { |
1871 total.width = wmax; | |
1872 total.height = y - y0; | |
1873 } | |
1874 | |
1875 return total; | |
1876 } | |
1877 | |
1878 | |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1879 /* Return the required height of glyph matrices for window W. */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1880 |
112023
ac49e05bfcf2
Remove unused declarations
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
112021
diff
changeset
|
1881 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1882 required_matrix_height (struct window *w) |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1883 { |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1884 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1885 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1886 |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1887 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1888 { |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1889 int ch_height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f); |
85252 | 1890 int window_pixel_height = window_box_height (w) + eabs (w->vscroll); |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1891 return (((window_pixel_height + ch_height - 1) |
56496
069e4841ceb2
(margin_glyphs_to_reserve): Apply ncols_scale_factor.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
55021
diff
changeset
|
1892 / ch_height) * w->nrows_scale_factor |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1893 /* One partially visible line at the top and |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1894 bottom of the window. */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1895 + 2 |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
1896 /* 2 for header and mode line. */ |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1897 + 2); |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1898 } |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1899 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1900 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
1901 return WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w); |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1902 } |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1903 |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1904 |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1905 /* Return the required width of glyph matrices for window W. */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1906 |
112023
ac49e05bfcf2
Remove unused declarations
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
112021
diff
changeset
|
1907 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1908 required_matrix_width (struct window *w) |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1909 { |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1910 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1911 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1912 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1913 { |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1914 int ch_width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f); |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
1915 int window_pixel_width = WINDOW_TOTAL_WIDTH (w); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1916 |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1917 /* Compute number of glyphs needed in a glyph row. */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1918 return (((window_pixel_width + ch_width - 1) |
56496
069e4841ceb2
(margin_glyphs_to_reserve): Apply ncols_scale_factor.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
55021
diff
changeset
|
1919 / ch_width) * w->ncols_scale_factor |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1920 /* 2 partially visible columns in the text area. */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1921 + 2 |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1922 /* One partially visible column at the right |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1923 edge of each marginal area. */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1924 + 1 + 1); |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1925 } |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1926 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */ |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1927 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
1928 return XINT (w->total_cols); |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1929 } |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1930 |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1931 |
25012 | 1932 /* Allocate window matrices for window-based redisplay. W is the |
73383
015a870c0c9a
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Remove unused variable ch_dim.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73318
diff
changeset
|
1933 window whose matrices must be allocated/reallocated. */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1934 |
25012 | 1935 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1936 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (struct window *w) |
25012 | 1937 { |
1938 while (w) | |
314 | 1939 { |
25012 | 1940 if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1941 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); |
25012 | 1942 else if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1943 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); |
25012 | 1944 else |
314 | 1945 { |
25012 | 1946 /* W is a leaf window. */ |
1947 struct dim dim; | |
1948 | |
1949 /* If matrices are not yet allocated, allocate them now. */ | |
1950 if (w->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
314 | 1951 { |
25012 | 1952 w->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (NULL); |
1953 w->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (NULL); | |
314 | 1954 } |
25012 | 1955 |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1956 dim.width = required_matrix_width (w); |
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
1957 dim.height = required_matrix_height (w); |
25012 | 1958 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->desired_matrix, 0, 0, dim); |
1959 adjust_glyph_matrix (w, w->current_matrix, 0, 0, dim); | |
1960 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1961 |
25012 | 1962 w = NILP (w->next) ? NULL : XWINDOW (w->next); |
1963 } | |
1964 } | |
1965 | |
1966 | |
1967 /* Re-allocate/ re-compute glyph matrices on frame F. If F is null, | |
1968 do it for all frames; otherwise do it just for the given frame. | |
1969 This function must be called when a new frame is created, its size | |
1970 changes, or its window configuration changes. */ | |
1971 | |
1972 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1973 adjust_glyphs (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 1974 { |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1975 /* Block input so that expose events and other events that access |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1976 glyph matrices are not processed while we are changing them. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1977 BLOCK_INPUT; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1978 |
25012 | 1979 if (f) |
1980 adjust_frame_glyphs (f); | |
1981 else | |
1982 { | |
1983 Lisp_Object tail, lisp_frame; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1984 |
25012 | 1985 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, lisp_frame) |
1986 adjust_frame_glyphs (XFRAME (lisp_frame)); | |
1987 } | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1988 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
1989 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
25012 | 1990 } |
1991 | |
1992 | |
1993 /* Adjust frame glyphs when Emacs is initialized. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1994 |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1995 To be called from init_display. |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
1996 |
25012 | 1997 We need a glyph matrix because redraw will happen soon. |
1998 Unfortunately, window sizes on selected_frame are not yet set to | |
1999 meaningful values. I believe we can assume that there are only two | |
2000 windows on the frame---the mini-buffer and the root window. Frame | |
2001 height and width seem to be correct so far. So, set the sizes of | |
2002 windows to estimated values. */ | |
2003 | |
2004 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2005 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (void) |
25012 | 2006 { |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2007 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2008 struct window *root = XWINDOW (sf->root_window); |
25012 | 2009 struct window *mini = XWINDOW (root->next); |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2010 int frame_lines = FRAME_LINES (sf); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2011 int frame_cols = FRAME_COLS (sf); |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2012 int top_margin = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (sf); |
25012 | 2013 |
2014 /* Do it for the root window. */ | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2015 XSETFASTINT (root->top_line, top_margin); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2016 XSETFASTINT (root->total_cols, frame_cols); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2017 set_window_height (sf->root_window, frame_lines - 1 - top_margin, 0); |
25012 | 2018 |
2019 /* Do it for the mini-buffer window. */ | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2020 XSETFASTINT (mini->top_line, frame_lines - 1); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2021 XSETFASTINT (mini->total_cols, frame_cols); |
25012 | 2022 set_window_height (root->next, 1, 0); |
2023 | |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
2024 adjust_frame_glyphs (sf); |
25012 | 2025 glyphs_initialized_initially_p = 1; |
2026 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2027 |
25012 | 2028 |
2029 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F. */ | |
2030 | |
2031 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2032 adjust_frame_glyphs (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2033 { |
2034 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) | |
2035 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (f); | |
2036 else | |
2037 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (f); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2038 |
25012 | 2039 /* Don't forget the message buffer and the buffer for |
2040 decode_mode_spec. */ | |
2041 adjust_frame_message_buffer (f); | |
2042 adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (f); | |
2043 | |
2044 f->glyphs_initialized_p = 1; | |
2045 } | |
2046 | |
77267
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2047 /* Return 1 if any window in the tree has nonzero window margins. See |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2048 the hack at the end of adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay. */ |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2049 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2050 showing_window_margins_p (struct window *w) |
77267
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2051 { |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2052 while (w) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2053 { |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2054 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2055 { |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2056 if (showing_window_margins_p (XWINDOW (w->hchild))) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2057 return 1; |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2058 } |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2059 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2060 { |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2061 if (showing_window_margins_p (XWINDOW (w->vchild))) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2062 return 1; |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2063 } |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2064 else if (!NILP (w->left_margin_cols) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2065 || !NILP (w->right_margin_cols)) |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2066 return 1; |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2067 |
77267
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2068 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2069 } |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2070 return 0; |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2071 } |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2072 |
25012 | 2073 |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2074 /* In the window tree with root W, build current matrices of leaf |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2075 windows from the frame's current matrix. */ |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2076 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2077 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2078 fake_current_matrices (Lisp_Object window) |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2079 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2080 struct window *w; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2081 |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2082 for (; !NILP (window); window = w->next) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2083 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2084 w = XWINDOW (window); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2085 |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2086 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2087 fake_current_matrices (w->hchild); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2088 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2089 fake_current_matrices (w->vchild); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2090 else |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2091 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2092 int i; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2093 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2094 struct glyph_matrix *m = w->current_matrix; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2095 struct glyph_matrix *fm = f->current_matrix; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2096 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2097 xassert (m->matrix_h == WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2098 xassert (m->matrix_w == WINDOW_TOTAL_COLS (w)); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2099 |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2100 for (i = 0; i < m->matrix_h; ++i) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2101 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2102 struct glyph_row *r = m->rows + i; |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2103 struct glyph_row *fr = fm->rows + i + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w); |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2104 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2105 xassert (r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] >= fr->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2106 && r->glyphs[LAST_AREA] <= fr->glyphs[LAST_AREA]); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2107 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2108 r->enabled_p = fr->enabled_p; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2109 if (r->enabled_p) |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2110 { |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2111 r->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] = m->left_margin_glyphs; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2112 r->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] = m->right_margin_glyphs; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2113 r->used[TEXT_AREA] = (m->matrix_w |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2114 - r->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2115 - r->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]); |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2116 r->mode_line_p = 0; |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2117 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2118 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2119 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2120 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2121 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2122 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2123 |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2124 /* Save away the contents of frame F's current frame matrix. Value is |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
2125 a glyph matrix holding the contents of F's current frame matrix. */ |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2126 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2127 static struct glyph_matrix * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2128 save_current_matrix (struct frame *f) |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2129 { |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2130 int i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2131 struct glyph_matrix *saved; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2132 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2133 saved = (struct glyph_matrix *) xmalloc (sizeof *saved); |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2134 memset (saved, 0, sizeof *saved); |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2135 saved->nrows = f->current_matrix->nrows; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2136 saved->rows = (struct glyph_row *) xmalloc (saved->nrows |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2137 * sizeof *saved->rows); |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2138 memset (saved->rows, 0, saved->nrows * sizeof *saved->rows); |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2139 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2140 for (i = 0; i < saved->nrows; ++i) |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2141 { |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2142 struct glyph_row *from = f->current_matrix->rows + i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2143 struct glyph_row *to = saved->rows + i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2144 size_t nbytes = from->used[TEXT_AREA] * sizeof (struct glyph); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2145 to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] = (struct glyph *) xmalloc (nbytes); |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2146 memcpy (to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], nbytes); |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2147 to->used[TEXT_AREA] = from->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2148 } |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2149 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2150 return saved; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2151 } |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2152 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2153 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2154 /* Restore the contents of frame F's current frame matrix from SAVED, |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2155 and free memory associated with SAVED. */ |
34849
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2156 |
eac70be4cb58
(save_frame_matrix, restore_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34788
diff
changeset
|
2157 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2158 restore_current_matrix (struct frame *f, struct glyph_matrix *saved) |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2159 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2160 int i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2161 |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2162 for (i = 0; i < saved->nrows; ++i) |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2163 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2164 struct glyph_row *from = saved->rows + i; |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2165 struct glyph_row *to = f->current_matrix->rows + i; |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2166 size_t nbytes = from->used[TEXT_AREA] * sizeof (struct glyph); |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2167 memcpy (to->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], nbytes); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2168 to->used[TEXT_AREA] = from->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2169 xfree (from->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2170 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2171 |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2172 xfree (saved->rows); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2173 xfree (saved); |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2174 } |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2175 |
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2176 |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2177 |
25012 | 2178 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F for |
2179 frame-based redisplay. */ | |
2180 | |
2181 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2182 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2183 { |
2184 struct dim matrix_dim; | |
2185 int pool_changed_p; | |
2186 int window_change_flags; | |
2187 int top_window_y; | |
2188 | |
2189 if (!FRAME_LIVE_P (f)) | |
2190 return; | |
2191 | |
2192 top_window_y = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f); | |
2193 | |
2194 /* Allocate glyph pool structures if not already done. */ | |
2195 if (f->desired_pool == NULL) | |
2196 { | |
2197 f->desired_pool = new_glyph_pool (); | |
2198 f->current_pool = new_glyph_pool (); | |
2199 } | |
2200 | |
2201 /* Allocate frames matrix structures if needed. */ | |
2202 if (f->desired_matrix == NULL) | |
2203 { | |
2204 f->desired_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->desired_pool); | |
2205 f->current_matrix = new_glyph_matrix (f->current_pool); | |
2206 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2207 |
25012 | 2208 /* Compute window glyph matrices. (This takes the mini-buffer |
2209 window into account). The result is the size of the frame glyph | |
2210 matrix needed. The variable window_change_flags is set to a bit | |
2211 mask indicating whether new matrices will be allocated or | |
2212 existing matrices change their size or location within the frame | |
2213 matrix. */ | |
2214 window_change_flags = 0; | |
2215 matrix_dim | |
2216 = allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
2217 0, top_window_y, | |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2218 1, |
25012 | 2219 &window_change_flags); |
2220 | |
2221 /* Add in menu bar lines, if any. */ | |
2222 matrix_dim.height += top_window_y; | |
2223 | |
2224 /* Enlarge pools as necessary. */ | |
2225 pool_changed_p = realloc_glyph_pool (f->desired_pool, matrix_dim); | |
2226 realloc_glyph_pool (f->current_pool, matrix_dim); | |
2227 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2228 /* Set up glyph pointers within window matrices. Do this only if |
25012 | 2229 absolutely necessary since it requires a frame redraw. */ |
2230 if (pool_changed_p || window_change_flags) | |
2231 { | |
2232 /* Do it for window matrices. */ | |
2233 allocate_matrices_for_frame_redisplay (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2234 0, top_window_y, 0, |
25012 | 2235 &window_change_flags); |
2236 | |
2237 /* Size of frame matrices must equal size of frame. Note | |
2238 that we are called for X frames with window widths NOT equal | |
2239 to the frame width (from CHANGE_FRAME_SIZE_1). */ | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2240 xassert (matrix_dim.width == FRAME_COLS (f) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2241 && matrix_dim.height == FRAME_LINES (f)); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2242 |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2243 /* Pointers to glyph memory in glyph rows are exchanged during |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2244 the update phase of redisplay, which means in general that a |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2245 frame's current matrix consists of pointers into both the |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2246 desired and current glyph pool of the frame. Adjusting a |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2247 matrix sets the frame matrix up so that pointers are all into |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2248 the same pool. If we want to preserve glyph contents of the |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2249 current matrix over a call to adjust_glyph_matrix, we must |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2250 make a copy of the current glyphs, and restore the current |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2251 matrix' contents from that copy. */ |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2252 if (display_completed |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2253 && !FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f) |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2254 && matrix_dim.width == f->current_matrix->matrix_w |
77267
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2255 && matrix_dim.height == f->current_matrix->matrix_h |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2256 /* For some reason, the frame glyph matrix gets corrupted if |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2257 any of the windows contain margins. I haven't been able |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2258 to hunt down the reason, but for the moment this prevents |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2259 the problem from manifesting. -- cyd */ |
7f8bdfdc0227
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Set garbaged flag in
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
76621
diff
changeset
|
2260 && !showing_window_margins_p (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)))) |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2261 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2262 struct glyph_matrix *copy = save_current_matrix (f); |
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2263 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->desired_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2264 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->current_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2265 restore_current_matrix (f, copy); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2266 fake_current_matrices (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2267 } |
34736
51a0fe34dfc6
(fake_current_matrices, ensure_frame_matrix): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34715
diff
changeset
|
2268 else |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2269 { |
35307
8e3c6f1a31ab
(save_or_restore_current_matrices): Function removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35269
diff
changeset
|
2270 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->desired_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
34788
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2271 adjust_glyph_matrix (NULL, f->current_matrix, 0, 0, matrix_dim); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2272 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
9512f05b60d1
(ensure_frame_matrix): Removed.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34736
diff
changeset
|
2273 } |
25012 | 2274 } |
2275 } | |
2276 | |
2277 | |
2278 /* Allocate/reallocate glyph matrices of a single frame F for | |
2279 window-based redisplay. */ | |
2280 | |
2281 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2282 adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2283 { |
2284 struct window *w; | |
2285 | |
2286 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f) && FRAME_LIVE_P (f)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2287 |
25012 | 2288 /* Allocate/reallocate window matrices. */ |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2289 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); |
25012 | 2290 |
73383
015a870c0c9a
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_frame_redisplay): Remove unused variable ch_dim.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73318
diff
changeset
|
2291 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS |
25012 | 2292 /* Allocate/ reallocate matrices of the dummy window used to display |
2293 the menu bar under X when no X toolkit support is available. */ | |
49322 | 2294 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK) |
25012 | 2295 { |
2296 /* Allocate a dummy window if not already done. */ | |
2297 if (NILP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
2298 { | |
2299 f->menu_bar_window = make_window (); | |
2300 w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
2301 XSETFRAME (w->frame, f); | |
2302 w->pseudo_window_p = 1; | |
2303 } | |
2304 else | |
2305 w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
2306 | |
2307 /* Set window dimensions to frame dimensions and allocate or | |
2308 adjust glyph matrices of W. */ | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2309 XSETFASTINT (w->top_line, 0); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2310 XSETFASTINT (w->left_col, 0); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2311 XSETFASTINT (w->total_lines, FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2312 XSETFASTINT (w->total_cols, FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)); |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2313 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w); |
25012 | 2314 } |
73402
c76709b3cbc0
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay): Fix #endif comments.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73383
diff
changeset
|
2315 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */ |
c76709b3cbc0
(adjust_frame_glyphs_for_window_redisplay): Fix #endif comments.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
73383
diff
changeset
|
2316 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ |
25012 | 2317 |
49322 | 2318 #ifndef USE_GTK |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2319 /* Allocate/ reallocate matrices of the tool bar window. If we |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2320 don't have a tool bar window yet, make one. */ |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2321 if (NILP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
25012 | 2322 { |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2323 f->tool_bar_window = make_window (); |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2324 w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 2325 XSETFRAME (w->frame, f); |
2326 w->pseudo_window_p = 1; | |
2327 } | |
2328 else | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2329 w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 2330 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2331 XSETFASTINT (w->top_line, FRAME_MENU_BAR_LINES (f)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2332 XSETFASTINT (w->left_col, 0); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2333 XSETFASTINT (w->total_lines, FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2334 XSETFASTINT (w->total_cols, FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)); |
39448
b74c165ef22f
(required_matrix_width, required_matrix_height): New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39254
diff
changeset
|
2335 allocate_matrices_for_window_redisplay (w); |
49322 | 2336 #endif |
25012 | 2337 } |
2338 | |
2339 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2340 /* Adjust/ allocate message buffer of frame F. |
25012 | 2341 |
2342 Note that the message buffer is never freed. Since I could not | |
2343 find a free in 19.34, I assume that freeing it would be | |
2344 problematic in some way and don't do it either. | |
2345 | |
2346 (Implementation note: It should be checked if we can free it | |
2347 eventually without causing trouble). */ | |
2348 | |
2349 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2350 adjust_frame_message_buffer (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2351 { |
2352 int size = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) + 1; | |
2353 | |
2354 if (FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f)) | |
2355 { | |
2356 char *buffer = FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f); | |
2357 char *new_buffer = (char *) xrealloc (buffer, size); | |
2358 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f) = new_buffer; | |
2359 } | |
2360 else | |
2361 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF (f) = (char *) xmalloc (size); | |
2362 } | |
2363 | |
2364 | |
2365 /* Re-allocate buffer for decode_mode_spec on frame F. */ | |
2366 | |
2367 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2368 adjust_decode_mode_spec_buffer (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2369 { |
2370 f->decode_mode_spec_buffer | |
2371 = (char *) xrealloc (f->decode_mode_spec_buffer, | |
2372 FRAME_MESSAGE_BUF_SIZE (f) + 1); | |
2373 } | |
2374 | |
2375 | |
2376 | |
2377 /********************************************************************** | |
2378 Freeing Glyph Matrices | |
2379 **********************************************************************/ | |
2380 | |
2381 /* Free glyph memory for a frame F. F may be null. This function can | |
2382 be called for the same frame more than once. The root window of | |
2383 F may be nil when this function is called. This is the case when | |
2384 the function is called when F is destroyed. */ | |
2385 | |
2386 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2387 free_glyphs (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2388 { |
2389 if (f && f->glyphs_initialized_p) | |
2390 { | |
27968
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2391 /* Block interrupt input so that we don't get surprised by an X |
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2392 event while we're in an inconsistent state. */ |
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2393 BLOCK_INPUT; |
25012 | 2394 f->glyphs_initialized_p = 0; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2395 |
25012 | 2396 /* Release window sub-matrices. */ |
2397 if (!NILP (f->root_window)) | |
2398 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (f->root_window)); | |
2399 | |
2400 /* Free the dummy window for menu bars without X toolkit and its | |
2401 glyph matrices. */ | |
2402 if (!NILP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
2403 { | |
2404 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window); | |
2405 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
2406 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
2407 w->desired_matrix = w->current_matrix = NULL; | |
2408 f->menu_bar_window = Qnil; | |
2409 } | |
2410 | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2411 /* Free the tool bar window and its glyph matrices. */ |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2412 if (!NILP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
25012 | 2413 { |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2414 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 2415 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); |
2416 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
2417 w->desired_matrix = w->current_matrix = NULL; | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
2418 f->tool_bar_window = Qnil; |
25012 | 2419 } |
2420 | |
2421 /* Release frame glyph matrices. Reset fields to zero in | |
2422 case we are called a second time. */ | |
2423 if (f->desired_matrix) | |
2424 { | |
2425 free_glyph_matrix (f->desired_matrix); | |
2426 free_glyph_matrix (f->current_matrix); | |
2427 f->desired_matrix = f->current_matrix = NULL; | |
2428 } | |
2429 | |
2430 /* Release glyph pools. */ | |
2431 if (f->desired_pool) | |
2432 { | |
2433 free_glyph_pool (f->desired_pool); | |
2434 free_glyph_pool (f->current_pool); | |
2435 f->desired_pool = f->current_pool = NULL; | |
314 | 2436 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2437 |
27968
7634011b93f3
(free_glyphs): Block input while freeing matrices.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27855
diff
changeset
|
2438 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
314 | 2439 } |
2440 } | |
2441 | |
25012 | 2442 |
2443 /* Free glyph sub-matrices in the window tree rooted at W. This | |
2444 function may be called with a null pointer, and it may be called on | |
2445 the same tree more than once. */ | |
2446 | |
2447 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2448 free_window_matrices (struct window *w) |
25012 | 2449 { |
2450 while (w) | |
2451 { | |
2452 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
2453 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
2454 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
2455 free_window_matrices (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2456 else |
25012 | 2457 { |
2458 /* This is a leaf window. Free its memory and reset fields | |
2459 to zero in case this function is called a second time for | |
2460 W. */ | |
2461 free_glyph_matrix (w->current_matrix); | |
2462 free_glyph_matrix (w->desired_matrix); | |
2463 w->current_matrix = w->desired_matrix = NULL; | |
2464 } | |
2465 | |
2466 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
2467 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
2468 } | |
2469 } | |
2470 | |
2471 | |
2472 /* Check glyph memory leaks. This function is called from | |
2473 shut_down_emacs. Note that frames are not destroyed when Emacs | |
2474 exits. We therefore free all glyph memory for all active frames | |
2475 explicitly and check that nothing is left allocated. */ | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2476 |
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2477 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2478 check_glyph_memory (void) |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2479 { |
25012 | 2480 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
2481 | |
2482 /* Free glyph memory for all frames. */ | |
2483 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
2484 free_glyphs (XFRAME (frame)); | |
2485 | |
2486 /* Check that nothing is left allocated. */ | |
2487 if (glyph_matrix_count) | |
2488 abort (); | |
2489 if (glyph_pool_count) | |
2490 abort (); | |
2491 } | |
2492 | |
2493 | |
2494 | |
2495 /********************************************************************** | |
2496 Building a Frame Matrix | |
2497 **********************************************************************/ | |
2498 | |
2499 /* Most of the redisplay code works on glyph matrices attached to | |
2500 windows. This is a good solution most of the time, but it is not | |
2501 suitable for terminal code. Terminal output functions cannot rely | |
2502 on being able to set an arbitrary terminal window. Instead they | |
2503 must be provided with a view of the whole frame, i.e. the whole | |
2504 screen. We build such a view by constructing a frame matrix from | |
2505 window matrices in this section. | |
2506 | |
2507 Windows that must be updated have their must_be_update_p flag set. | |
2508 For all such windows, their desired matrix is made part of the | |
2509 desired frame matrix. For other windows, their current matrix is | |
2510 made part of the desired frame matrix. | |
2511 | |
2512 +-----------------+----------------+ | |
2513 | desired | desired | | |
2514 | | | | |
2515 +-----------------+----------------+ | |
2516 | current | | |
2517 | | | |
2518 +----------------------------------+ | |
2519 | |
2520 Desired window matrices can be made part of the frame matrix in a | |
2521 cheap way: We exploit the fact that the desired frame matrix and | |
2522 desired window matrices share their glyph memory. This is not | |
2523 possible for current window matrices. Their glyphs are copied to | |
2524 the desired frame matrix. The latter is equivalent to | |
2525 preserve_other_columns in the old redisplay. | |
2526 | |
2527 Used glyphs counters for frame matrix rows are the result of adding | |
2528 up glyph lengths of the window matrices. A line in the frame | |
2529 matrix is enabled, if a corresponding line in a window matrix is | |
2530 enabled. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2531 |
25012 | 2532 After building the desired frame matrix, it will be passed to |
2533 terminal code, which will manipulate both the desired and current | |
2534 frame matrix. Changes applied to the frame's current matrix have | |
2535 to be visible in current window matrices afterwards, of course. | |
2536 | |
2537 This problem is solved like this: | |
2538 | |
2539 1. Window and frame matrices share glyphs. Window matrices are | |
2540 constructed in a way that their glyph contents ARE the glyph | |
2541 contents needed in a frame matrix. Thus, any modification of | |
2542 glyphs done in terminal code will be reflected in window matrices | |
2543 automatically. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2544 |
25012 | 2545 2. Exchanges of rows in a frame matrix done by terminal code are |
2546 intercepted by hook functions so that corresponding row operations | |
2547 on window matrices can be performed. This is necessary because we | |
2548 use pointers to glyphs in glyph row structures. To satisfy the | |
2549 assumption of point 1 above that glyphs are updated implicitly in | |
2550 window matrices when they are manipulated via the frame matrix, | |
2551 window and frame matrix must of course agree where to find the | |
2552 glyphs for their rows. Possible manipulations that must be | |
2553 mirrored are assignments of rows of the desired frame matrix to the | |
2554 current frame matrix and scrolling the current frame matrix. */ | |
2555 | |
2556 /* Build frame F's desired matrix from window matrices. Only windows | |
2557 which have the flag must_be_updated_p set have to be updated. Menu | |
2558 bar lines of a frame are not covered by window matrices, so make | |
2559 sure not to touch them in this function. */ | |
2560 | |
2561 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2562 build_frame_matrix (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2563 { |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2564 int i; |
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2565 |
25012 | 2566 /* F must have a frame matrix when this function is called. */ |
2567 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2568 |
25012 | 2569 /* Clear all rows in the frame matrix covered by window matrices. |
2570 Menu bar lines are not covered by windows. */ | |
2571 for (i = FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f); i < f->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i) | |
2572 clear_glyph_row (MATRIX_ROW (f->desired_matrix, i)); | |
2573 | |
2574 /* Build the matrix by walking the window tree. */ | |
2575 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (f->desired_matrix, | |
2576 XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))); | |
2577 } | |
2578 | |
2579 | |
2580 /* Walk a window tree, building a frame matrix MATRIX from window | |
2581 matrices. W is the root of a window tree. */ | |
2582 | |
2583 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2584 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, struct window *w) |
25012 | 2585 { |
2586 while (w) | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2587 { |
25012 | 2588 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
2589 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
2590 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
2591 build_frame_matrix_from_window_tree (matrix, XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
2592 else | |
2593 build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (matrix, w); | |
2594 | |
2595 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
6620
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2596 } |
990d7d5095dc
(adjust_window_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6617
diff
changeset
|
2597 } |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2598 |
25012 | 2599 |
2600 /* Add a window's matrix to a frame matrix. FRAME_MATRIX is the | |
2601 desired frame matrix built. W is a leaf window whose desired or | |
2602 current matrix is to be added to FRAME_MATRIX. W's flag | |
2603 must_be_updated_p determines which matrix it contributes to | |
2604 FRAME_MATRIX. If must_be_updated_p is non-zero, W's desired matrix | |
2605 is added to FRAME_MATRIX, otherwise W's current matrix is added. | |
2606 Adding a desired matrix means setting up used counters and such in | |
2607 frame rows, while adding a current window matrix to FRAME_MATRIX | |
2608 means copying glyphs. The latter case corresponds to | |
2609 preserve_other_columns in the old redisplay. */ | |
2610 | |
2611 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2612 build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window (struct glyph_matrix *frame_matrix, struct window *w) |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2613 { |
25012 | 2614 struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix; |
2615 int window_y, frame_y; | |
2616 /* If non-zero, a glyph to insert at the right border of W. */ | |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2617 GLYPH right_border_glyph; |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2618 |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2619 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (right_border_glyph, 0); |
25012 | 2620 |
2621 /* Set window_matrix to the matrix we have to add to FRAME_MATRIX. */ | |
2622 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
2623 { | |
2624 window_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
2625 | |
2626 /* Decide whether we want to add a vertical border glyph. */ | |
2627 if (!WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)) | |
2628 { | |
2629 struct Lisp_Char_Table *dp = window_display_table (w); | |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2630 Lisp_Object gc; |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2631 |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2632 SET_GLYPH_FROM_CHAR (right_border_glyph, '|'); |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2633 if (dp |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2634 && (gc = DISP_BORDER_GLYPH (dp), GLYPH_CODE_P (gc)) |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2635 && GLYPH_CODE_CHAR_VALID_P (gc)) |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2636 { |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2637 SET_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH_CODE (right_border_glyph, gc); |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2638 spec_glyph_lookup_face (w, &right_border_glyph); |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2639 } |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2640 |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2641 if (GLYPH_FACE (right_border_glyph) <= 0) |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2642 SET_GLYPH_FACE (right_border_glyph, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID); |
25012 | 2643 } |
2644 } | |
2645 else | |
2646 window_matrix = w->current_matrix; | |
2647 | |
2648 /* For all rows in the window matrix and corresponding rows in the | |
2649 frame matrix. */ | |
2650 window_y = 0; | |
2651 frame_y = window_matrix->matrix_y; | |
2652 while (window_y < window_matrix->nrows) | |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2653 { |
25012 | 2654 struct glyph_row *frame_row = frame_matrix->rows + frame_y; |
2655 struct glyph_row *window_row = window_matrix->rows + window_y; | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2656 int current_row_p = window_matrix == w->current_matrix; |
25012 | 2657 |
2658 /* Fill up the frame row with spaces up to the left margin of the | |
2659 window row. */ | |
2660 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (frame_row, window_matrix->matrix_x); | |
2661 | |
2662 /* Fill up areas in the window matrix row with spaces. */ | |
2663 fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (window_row); | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2664 |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2665 /* If only part of W's desired matrix has been built, and |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2666 window_row wasn't displayed, use the corresponding current |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2667 row instead. */ |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2668 if (window_matrix == w->desired_matrix |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2669 && !window_row->enabled_p) |
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2670 { |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2671 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows + window_y; |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2672 current_row_p = 1; |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2673 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2674 |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2675 if (current_row_p) |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2676 { |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2677 /* Copy window row to frame row. */ |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2678 memcpy (frame_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + window_matrix->matrix_x, |
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2679 window_row->glyphs[0], |
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2680 window_matrix->matrix_w * sizeof (struct glyph)); |
25012 | 2681 } |
2682 else | |
2683 { | |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2684 xassert (window_row->enabled_p); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2685 |
31271
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2686 /* Only when a desired row has been displayed, we want |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2687 the corresponding frame row to be updated. */ |
4f0c5eecc5a6
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window): If a row of a
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31093
diff
changeset
|
2688 frame_row->enabled_p = 1; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2689 |
25012 | 2690 /* Maybe insert a vertical border between horizontally adjacent |
2691 windows. */ | |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2692 if (GLYPH_CHAR (right_border_glyph) != 0) |
25012 | 2693 { |
2694 struct glyph *border = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - 1; | |
2695 SET_CHAR_GLYPH_FROM_GLYPH (*border, right_border_glyph); | |
2696 } | |
2697 | |
59902
4a0a167cb6c4
(build_frame_matrix_from_leaf_window)
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59879
diff
changeset
|
2698 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2699 /* Window row window_y must be a slice of frame row |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2700 frame_y. */ |
25012 | 2701 xassert (glyph_row_slice_p (window_row, frame_row)); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2702 |
25012 | 2703 /* If rows are in sync, we don't have to copy glyphs because |
2704 frame and window share glyphs. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2705 |
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2706 strcpy (w->current_matrix->method, w->desired_matrix->method); |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
2707 add_window_display_history (w, w->current_matrix->method, 0); |
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2708 #endif |
25012 | 2709 } |
2710 | |
2711 /* Set number of used glyphs in the frame matrix. Since we fill | |
2712 up with spaces, and visit leaf windows from left to right it | |
2713 can be done simply. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2714 frame_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
25012 | 2715 = window_matrix->matrix_x + window_matrix->matrix_w; |
2716 | |
2717 /* Next row. */ | |
2718 ++window_y; | |
2719 ++frame_y; | |
2720 } | |
2721 } | |
2722 | |
63547
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2723 /* Given a user-specified glyph, possibly including a Lisp-level face |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2724 ID, return a glyph that has a realized face ID. |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2725 This is used for glyphs displayed specially and not part of the text; |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2726 for instance, vertical separators, truncation markers, etc. */ |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2727 |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2728 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2729 spec_glyph_lookup_face (struct window *w, GLYPH *glyph) |
63547
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2730 { |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2731 int lface_id = GLYPH_FACE (*glyph); |
63547
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2732 /* Convert the glyph's specified face to a realized (cache) face. */ |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2733 if (lface_id > 0) |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2734 { |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2735 int face_id = merge_faces (XFRAME (w->frame), |
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2736 Qt, lface_id, DEFAULT_FACE_ID); |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2737 SET_GLYPH_FACE (*glyph, face_id); |
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
2738 } |
63547
cbb687cf8169
(spec_glyph_lookup_face): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
61989
diff
changeset
|
2739 } |
25012 | 2740 |
2741 /* Add spaces to a glyph row ROW in a window matrix. | |
2742 | |
2743 Each row has the form: | |
2744 | |
2745 +---------+-----------------------------+------------+ | |
2746 | left | text | right | | |
2747 +---------+-----------------------------+------------+ | |
2748 | |
2749 Left and right marginal areas are optional. This function adds | |
2750 spaces to areas so that there are no empty holes between areas. | |
2751 In other words: If the right area is not empty, the text area | |
2752 is filled up with spaces up to the right area. If the text area | |
2753 is not empty, the left area is filled up. | |
2754 | |
2755 To be called for frame-based redisplay, only. */ | |
2756 | |
2757 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2758 fill_up_glyph_row_with_spaces (struct glyph_row *row) |
25012 | 2759 { |
2760 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA); | |
2761 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, TEXT_AREA); | |
2762 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA); | |
2763 } | |
2764 | |
2765 | |
2766 /* Fill area AREA of glyph row ROW with spaces. To be called for | |
2767 frame-based redisplay only. */ | |
2768 | |
2769 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2770 fill_up_glyph_row_area_with_spaces (struct glyph_row *row, int area) |
25012 | 2771 { |
2772 if (row->glyphs[area] < row->glyphs[area + 1]) | |
2773 { | |
2774 struct glyph *end = row->glyphs[area + 1]; | |
2775 struct glyph *text = row->glyphs[area] + row->used[area]; | |
2776 | |
2777 while (text < end) | |
2778 *text++ = space_glyph; | |
2779 row->used[area] = text - row->glyphs[area]; | |
2780 } | |
2781 } | |
2782 | |
2783 | |
2784 /* Add spaces to the end of ROW in a frame matrix until index UPTO is | |
2785 reached. In frame matrices only one area, TEXT_AREA, is used. */ | |
2786 | |
2787 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2788 fill_up_frame_row_with_spaces (struct glyph_row *row, int upto) |
25012 | 2789 { |
2790 int i = row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
2791 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2792 |
25012 | 2793 while (i < upto) |
2794 glyph[i++] = space_glyph; | |
2795 | |
2796 row->used[TEXT_AREA] = i; | |
2797 } | |
2798 | |
2799 | |
2800 | |
2801 /********************************************************************** | |
2802 Mirroring operations on frame matrices in window matrices | |
2803 **********************************************************************/ | |
2804 | |
2805 /* Set frame being updated via frame-based redisplay to F. This | |
2806 function must be called before updates to make explicit that we are | |
2807 working on frame matrices or not. */ | |
2808 | |
2809 static INLINE void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2810 set_frame_matrix_frame (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 2811 { |
2812 frame_matrix_frame = f; | |
2813 } | |
2814 | |
2815 | |
2816 /* Make sure glyph row ROW in CURRENT_MATRIX is up to date. | |
2817 DESIRED_MATRIX is the desired matrix corresponding to | |
2818 CURRENT_MATRIX. The update is done by exchanging glyph pointers | |
2819 between rows in CURRENT_MATRIX and DESIRED_MATRIX. If | |
2820 frame_matrix_frame is non-null, this indicates that the exchange is | |
2821 done in frame matrices, and that we have to perform analogous | |
2822 operations in window matrices of frame_matrix_frame. */ | |
2823 | |
2824 static INLINE void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2825 make_current (struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix, struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix, int row) |
25012 | 2826 { |
2827 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, row); | |
2828 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, row); | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
2829 int mouse_face_p = current_row->mouse_face_p; |
25012 | 2830 |
2831 /* Do current_row = desired_row. This exchanges glyph pointers | |
2832 between both rows, and does a structure assignment otherwise. */ | |
2833 assign_row (current_row, desired_row); | |
2834 | |
2835 /* Enable current_row to mark it as valid. */ | |
2836 current_row->enabled_p = 1; | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
2837 current_row->mouse_face_p = mouse_face_p; |
25012 | 2838 |
2839 /* If we are called on frame matrices, perform analogous operations | |
2840 for window matrices. */ | |
2841 if (frame_matrix_frame) | |
2842 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (frame_matrix_frame->root_window), row); | |
2843 } | |
2844 | |
2845 | |
2846 /* W is the root of a window tree. FRAME_ROW is the index of a row in | |
2847 W's frame which has been made current (by swapping pointers between | |
2848 current and desired matrix). Perform analogous operations in the | |
2849 matrices of leaf windows in the window tree rooted at W. */ | |
2850 | |
2851 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2852 mirror_make_current (struct window *w, int frame_row) |
25012 | 2853 { |
2854 while (w) | |
2855 { | |
2856 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
2857 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (w->hchild), frame_row); | |
2858 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
2859 mirror_make_current (XWINDOW (w->vchild), frame_row); | |
2860 else | |
2861 { | |
2862 /* Row relative to window W. Don't use FRAME_TO_WINDOW_VPOS | |
2863 here because the checks performed in debug mode there | |
2864 will not allow the conversion. */ | |
2865 int row = frame_row - w->desired_matrix->matrix_y; | |
2866 | |
2867 /* If FRAME_ROW is within W, assign the desired row to the | |
2868 current row (exchanging glyph pointers). */ | |
2869 if (row >= 0 && row < w->desired_matrix->matrix_h) | |
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2870 { |
25012 | 2871 struct glyph_row *current_row |
2872 = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, row); | |
2873 struct glyph_row *desired_row | |
2874 = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, row); | |
25241
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2875 |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2876 if (desired_row->enabled_p) |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2877 assign_row (current_row, desired_row); |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2878 else |
35674d7c4136
(mirror_make_current): If desired row isn't enabled,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25190
diff
changeset
|
2879 swap_glyph_pointers (desired_row, current_row); |
25012 | 2880 current_row->enabled_p = 1; |
111339
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2881 |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2882 /* Set the Y coordinate of the mode/header line's row. |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2883 It is needed in draw_row_with_mouse_face to find the |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2884 screen coordinates. (Window-based redisplay sets |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2885 this in update_window, but no one seems to do that |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2886 for frame-based redisplay.) */ |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2887 if (current_row->mode_line_p) |
e302712538dc
Unify mouse highlight code of MSDOS and GUI sessions.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111163
diff
changeset
|
2888 current_row->y = row; |
6682
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2889 } |
16ab14205588
(verify_charstarts): Handle truncation of lines.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6648
diff
changeset
|
2890 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2891 |
25012 | 2892 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
6642
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2893 } |
2fda5dd17356
(verify_charstarts): New function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6627
diff
changeset
|
2894 } |
25012 | 2895 |
2896 | |
2897 /* Perform row dance after scrolling. We are working on the range of | |
2898 lines UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + 1 to UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + NLINES (not | |
2899 including) in MATRIX. COPY_FROM is a vector containing, for each | |
2900 row I in the range 0 <= I < NLINES, the index of the original line | |
2901 to move to I. This index is relative to the row range, i.e. 0 <= | |
2902 index < NLINES. RETAINED_P is a vector containing zero for each | |
2903 row 0 <= I < NLINES which is empty. | |
2904 | |
2905 This function is called from do_scrolling and do_direct_scrolling. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2906 |
25012 | 2907 void |
109360
f37b85834f7e
Convert more function definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109179
diff
changeset
|
2908 mirrored_line_dance (struct glyph_matrix *matrix, int unchanged_at_top, int nlines, |
f37b85834f7e
Convert more function definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109179
diff
changeset
|
2909 int *copy_from, char *retained_p) |
25012 | 2910 { |
2911 /* A copy of original rows. */ | |
2912 struct glyph_row *old_rows; | |
2913 | |
2914 /* Rows to assign to. */ | |
2915 struct glyph_row *new_rows = MATRIX_ROW (matrix, unchanged_at_top); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2916 |
25012 | 2917 int i; |
2918 | |
2919 /* Make a copy of the original rows. */ | |
2920 old_rows = (struct glyph_row *) alloca (nlines * sizeof *old_rows); | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2921 memcpy (old_rows, new_rows, nlines * sizeof *old_rows); |
25012 | 2922 |
2923 /* Assign new rows, maybe clear lines. */ | |
2924 for (i = 0; i < nlines; ++i) | |
2925 { | |
2926 int enabled_before_p = new_rows[i].enabled_p; | |
2927 | |
2928 xassert (i + unchanged_at_top < matrix->nrows); | |
2929 xassert (unchanged_at_top + copy_from[i] < matrix->nrows); | |
2930 new_rows[i] = old_rows[copy_from[i]]; | |
2931 new_rows[i].enabled_p = enabled_before_p; | |
2932 | |
2933 /* RETAINED_P is zero for empty lines. */ | |
2934 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) | |
2935 new_rows[i].enabled_p = 0; | |
2936 } | |
2937 | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
2938 /* Do the same for window matrices, if MATRIX is a frame matrix. */ |
25012 | 2939 if (frame_matrix_frame) |
2940 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (frame_matrix_frame->root_window), | |
2941 unchanged_at_top, nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
2942 } | |
2943 | |
2944 | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2945 /* Synchronize glyph pointers in the current matrix of window W with |
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2946 the current frame matrix. */ |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2947 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2948 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2949 sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows (struct window *w) |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2950 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2951 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2952 struct glyph_row *window_row, *window_row_end, *frame_row; |
40271
ae4848857075
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Remove unused variable `area'.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40214
diff
changeset
|
2953 int left, right, x, width; |
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2954 |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2955 /* Preconditions: W must be a leaf window on a tty frame. */ |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2956 xassert (NILP (w->hchild) && NILP (w->vchild)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2957 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2958 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2959 left = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, 1, w->left_margin_cols); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2960 right = margin_glyphs_to_reserve (w, 1, w->right_margin_cols); |
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2961 x = w->current_matrix->matrix_x; |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2962 width = w->current_matrix->matrix_w; |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2963 |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2964 window_row = w->current_matrix->rows; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2965 window_row_end = window_row + w->current_matrix->nrows; |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2966 frame_row = f->current_matrix->rows + WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2967 |
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2968 for (; window_row < window_row_end; ++window_row, ++frame_row) |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2969 { |
40214
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2970 window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2971 = frame_row->glyphs[0] + x; |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2972 window_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2973 = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + left; |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2974 window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2975 = window_row->glyphs[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA] + width; |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2976 window_row->glyphs[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA] |
a87bf217f5a6
(sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows): Fix
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40075
diff
changeset
|
2977 = window_row->glyphs[LAST_AREA] - right; |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2978 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2979 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2980 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2981 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2982 /* Return the window in the window tree rooted in W containing frame |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2983 row ROW. Value is null if none is found. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2984 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2985 struct window * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2986 frame_row_to_window (struct window *w, int row) |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2987 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2988 struct window *found = NULL; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2989 |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2990 while (w && !found) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2991 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2992 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2993 found = frame_row_to_window (XWINDOW (w->hchild), row); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2994 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2995 found = frame_row_to_window (XWINDOW (w->vchild), row); |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2996 else if (row >= WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
2997 && row < WINDOW_BOTTOM_EDGE_LINE (w)) |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
2998 found = w; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
2999 |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3000 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3001 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3002 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3003 return found; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3004 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3005 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3006 |
25012 | 3007 /* Perform a line dance in the window tree rooted at W, after |
3008 scrolling a frame matrix in mirrored_line_dance. | |
3009 | |
3010 We are working on the range of lines UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + 1 to | |
3011 UNCHANGED_AT_TOP + NLINES (not including) in W's frame matrix. | |
3012 COPY_FROM is a vector containing, for each row I in the range 0 <= | |
3013 I < NLINES, the index of the original line to move to I. This | |
3014 index is relative to the row range, i.e. 0 <= index < NLINES. | |
3015 RETAINED_P is a vector containing zero for each row 0 <= I < NLINES | |
3016 which is empty. */ | |
3017 | |
3018 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3019 mirror_line_dance (struct window *w, int unchanged_at_top, int nlines, int *copy_from, char *retained_p) |
25012 | 3020 { |
3021 while (w) | |
3022 { | |
3023 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
3024 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (w->hchild), unchanged_at_top, | |
3025 nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
3026 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
3027 mirror_line_dance (XWINDOW (w->vchild), unchanged_at_top, | |
3028 nlines, copy_from, retained_p); | |
3029 else | |
3030 { | |
3031 /* W is a leaf window, and we are working on its current | |
3032 matrix m. */ | |
3033 struct glyph_matrix *m = w->current_matrix; | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3034 int i, sync_p = 0; |
25012 | 3035 struct glyph_row *old_rows; |
3036 | |
3037 /* Make a copy of the original rows of matrix m. */ | |
3038 old_rows = (struct glyph_row *) alloca (m->nrows * sizeof *old_rows); | |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
3039 memcpy (old_rows, m->rows, m->nrows * sizeof *old_rows); |
25012 | 3040 |
3041 for (i = 0; i < nlines; ++i) | |
3042 { | |
3043 /* Frame relative line assigned to. */ | |
3044 int frame_to = i + unchanged_at_top; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3045 |
25012 | 3046 /* Frame relative line assigned. */ |
3047 int frame_from = copy_from[i] + unchanged_at_top; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3048 |
25012 | 3049 /* Window relative line assigned to. */ |
3050 int window_to = frame_to - m->matrix_y; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3051 |
25012 | 3052 /* Window relative line assigned. */ |
3053 int window_from = frame_from - m->matrix_y; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3054 |
25012 | 3055 /* Is assigned line inside window? */ |
3056 int from_inside_window_p | |
3057 = window_from >= 0 && window_from < m->matrix_h; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3058 |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3059 /* Is assigned to line inside window? */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3060 int to_inside_window_p |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3061 = window_to >= 0 && window_to < m->matrix_h; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3062 |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3063 if (from_inside_window_p && to_inside_window_p) |
25012 | 3064 { |
3065 /* Enabled setting before assignment. */ | |
3066 int enabled_before_p; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3067 |
25012 | 3068 /* Do the assignment. The enabled_p flag is saved |
3069 over the assignment because the old redisplay did | |
3070 that. */ | |
3071 enabled_before_p = m->rows[window_to].enabled_p; | |
3072 m->rows[window_to] = old_rows[window_from]; | |
3073 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = enabled_before_p; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3074 |
25012 | 3075 /* If frame line is empty, window line is empty, too. */ |
3076 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) | |
3077 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = 0; | |
3078 } | |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3079 else if (to_inside_window_p) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3080 { |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3081 /* A copy between windows. This is an infrequent |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3082 case not worth optimizing. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3083 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3084 struct window *root = XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)); |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3085 struct window *w2; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3086 struct glyph_matrix *m2; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3087 int m2_from; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3088 |
60684
18bf961ed63a
(mirror_line_dance): Set W2 according to FRAME_FROM.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
59905
diff
changeset
|
3089 w2 = frame_row_to_window (root, frame_from); |
61416
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3090 /* ttn@surf.glug.org: when enabling menu bar using `emacs |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3091 -nw', FROM_FRAME sometimes has no associated window. |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3092 This check avoids a segfault if W2 is null. */ |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3093 if (w2) |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3094 { |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3095 m2 = w2->current_matrix; |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3096 m2_from = frame_from - m2->matrix_y; |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3097 copy_row_except_pointers (m->rows + window_to, |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3098 m2->rows + m2_from); |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3099 |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3100 /* If frame line is empty, window line is empty, too. */ |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3101 if (!retained_p[copy_from[i]]) |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3102 m->rows[window_to].enabled_p = 0; |
89b8166ef056
(mirror_line_dance): Avoid crash if W2 is null.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
60684
diff
changeset
|
3103 } |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3104 sync_p = 1; |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3105 } |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3106 else if (from_inside_window_p) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3107 sync_p = 1; |
25012 | 3108 } |
27855
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3109 |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3110 /* If there was a copy between windows, make sure glyph |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3111 pointers are in sync with the frame matrix. */ |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3112 if (sync_p) |
ecfe912fd73c
(flush_stdout) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New function.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
27727
diff
changeset
|
3113 sync_window_with_frame_matrix_rows (w); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3114 |
25012 | 3115 /* Check that no pointers are lost. */ |
3116 CHECK_MATRIX (m); | |
3117 } | |
3118 | |
3119 /* Next window on same level. */ | |
3120 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
3121 } | |
3122 } | |
3123 | |
3124 | |
3125 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
3126 | |
3127 /* Check that window and frame matrices agree about their | |
3128 understanding where glyphs of the rows are to find. For each | |
3129 window in the window tree rooted at W, check that rows in the | |
3130 matrices of leaf window agree with their frame matrices about | |
3131 glyph pointers. */ | |
314 | 3132 |
21514 | 3133 void |
112021 | 3134 check_window_matrix_pointers (struct window *w) |
314 | 3135 { |
25012 | 3136 while (w) |
3137 { | |
3138 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
3139 check_window_matrix_pointers (XWINDOW (w->hchild)); | |
3140 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
3141 check_window_matrix_pointers (XWINDOW (w->vchild)); | |
3142 else | |
3143 { | |
3144 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
3145 check_matrix_pointers (w->desired_matrix, f->desired_matrix); | |
3146 check_matrix_pointers (w->current_matrix, f->current_matrix); | |
3147 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3148 |
25012 | 3149 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
3150 } | |
3151 } | |
3152 | |
3153 | |
3154 /* Check that window rows are slices of frame rows. WINDOW_MATRIX is | |
3155 a window and FRAME_MATRIX is the corresponding frame matrix. For | |
3156 each row in WINDOW_MATRIX check that it's a slice of the | |
3157 corresponding frame row. If it isn't, abort. */ | |
3158 | |
3159 static void | |
112021 | 3160 check_matrix_pointers (struct glyph_matrix *window_matrix, |
3161 struct glyph_matrix *frame_matrix) | |
25012 | 3162 { |
3163 /* Row number in WINDOW_MATRIX. */ | |
3164 int i = 0; | |
3165 | |
3166 /* Row number corresponding to I in FRAME_MATRIX. */ | |
3167 int j = window_matrix->matrix_y; | |
3168 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3169 /* For all rows check that the row in the window matrix is a |
25012 | 3170 slice of the row in the frame matrix. If it isn't we didn't |
3171 mirror an operation on the frame matrix correctly. */ | |
3172 while (i < window_matrix->nrows) | |
3173 { | |
3174 if (!glyph_row_slice_p (window_matrix->rows + i, | |
3175 frame_matrix->rows + j)) | |
3176 abort (); | |
3177 ++i, ++j; | |
3178 } | |
3179 } | |
3180 | |
3181 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */ | |
3182 | |
3183 | |
3184 | |
3185 /********************************************************************** | |
3186 VPOS and HPOS translations | |
3187 **********************************************************************/ | |
3188 | |
3189 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
3190 | |
3191 /* Translate vertical position VPOS which is relative to window W to a | |
3192 vertical position relative to W's frame. */ | |
3193 | |
3194 static int | |
112021 | 3195 window_to_frame_vpos (struct window *w, int vpos) |
25012 | 3196 { |
3197 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3198 |
25012 | 3199 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); |
3200 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos <= w->desired_matrix->nrows); | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
3201 vpos += WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (w); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
3202 xassert (vpos >= 0 && vpos <= FRAME_LINES (f)); |
25012 | 3203 return vpos; |
3204 } | |
3205 | |
3206 | |
3207 /* Translate horizontal position HPOS which is relative to window W to | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3208 a horizontal position relative to W's frame. */ |
25012 | 3209 |
3210 static int | |
112021 | 3211 window_to_frame_hpos (struct window *w, int hpos) |
25012 | 3212 { |
65308
7b2a711dc863
(window_to_frame_hpos, update_window):
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
65016
diff
changeset
|
3213 xassert (!FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (w->frame))); |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
3214 hpos += WINDOW_LEFT_EDGE_COL (w); |
25012 | 3215 return hpos; |
314 | 3216 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3217 |
25012 | 3218 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
3219 | |
3220 | |
314 | 3221 |
25012 | 3222 /********************************************************************** |
3223 Redrawing Frames | |
3224 **********************************************************************/ | |
3225 | |
3226 DEFUN ("redraw-frame", Fredraw_frame, Sredraw_frame, 1, 1, 0, | |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
3227 doc: /* Clear frame FRAME and output again what is supposed to appear on it. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
3228 (Lisp_Object frame) |
25012 | 3229 { |
3230 struct frame *f; | |
3231 | |
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
3232 CHECK_LIVE_FRAME (frame); |
25012 | 3233 f = XFRAME (frame); |
3234 | |
3235 /* Ignore redraw requests, if frame has no glyphs yet. | |
3236 (Implementation note: It still has to be checked why we are | |
3237 called so early here). */ | |
3238 if (!glyphs_initialized_initially_p) | |
3239 return Qnil; | |
3240 | |
3241 update_begin (f); | |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
3242 #ifdef MSDOS |
35445
9af454aee182
(Fredraw_frame): Remove reference to
Andrew Innes <andrewi@gnu.org>
parents:
35374
diff
changeset
|
3243 if (FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
97646
fab72f02d115
(init_display): Remove MS-DOS specific conditions for calling
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97142
diff
changeset
|
3244 FRAME_TERMINAL (f)->set_terminal_modes_hook (FRAME_TERMINAL (f)); |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
3245 #endif |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
3246 clear_frame (f); |
25012 | 3247 clear_current_matrices (f); |
3248 update_end (f); | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
3249 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f)) |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
3250 fflush (FRAME_TTY (f)->output); |
25012 | 3251 windows_or_buffers_changed++; |
3252 /* Mark all windows as inaccurate, so that every window will have | |
3253 its redisplay done. */ | |
3254 mark_window_display_accurate (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), 0); | |
3255 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)), 1); | |
3256 f->garbaged = 0; | |
3257 return Qnil; | |
3258 } | |
3259 | |
3260 | |
3261 /* Redraw frame F. This is nothing more than a call to the Lisp | |
3262 function redraw-frame. */ | |
3263 | |
3264 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3265 redraw_frame (struct frame *f) |
25012 | 3266 { |
3267 Lisp_Object frame; | |
3268 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
3269 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
3270 } | |
3271 | |
3272 | |
3273 DEFUN ("redraw-display", Fredraw_display, Sredraw_display, 0, 0, "", | |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
3274 doc: /* Clear and redisplay all visible frames. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
3275 (void) |
25012 | 3276 { |
3277 Lisp_Object tail, frame; | |
3278 | |
3279 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
3280 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (frame))) | |
3281 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
3282 | |
3283 return Qnil; | |
3284 } | |
3285 | |
3286 | |
3287 /* This is used when frame_garbaged is set. Call Fredraw_frame on all | |
3288 visible frames marked as garbaged. */ | |
3289 | |
3290 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3291 redraw_garbaged_frames (void) |
25012 | 3292 { |
3293 Lisp_Object tail, frame; | |
3294 | |
3295 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
3296 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (XFRAME (frame)) | |
3297 && FRAME_GARBAGED_P (XFRAME (frame))) | |
3298 Fredraw_frame (frame); | |
3299 } | |
3300 | |
3301 | |
3302 | |
3303 /*********************************************************************** | |
3304 Frame Update | |
3305 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3306 | |
3307 /* Update frame F based on the data in desired matrices. | |
3308 | |
3309 If FORCE_P is non-zero, don't let redisplay be stopped by detecting | |
3310 pending input. If INHIBIT_HAIRY_ID_P is non-zero, don't try | |
3311 scrolling. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3312 |
25012 | 3313 Value is non-zero if redisplay was stopped due to pending input. */ |
314 | 3314 |
3315 int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3316 update_frame (struct frame *f, int force_p, int inhibit_hairy_id_p) |
25012 | 3317 { |
3318 /* 1 means display has been paused because of pending input. */ | |
3319 int paused_p; | |
3320 struct window *root_window = XWINDOW (f->root_window); | |
3321 | |
76065
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3322 if (redisplay_dont_pause) |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3323 force_p = 1; |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3324 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
76065
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3325 else if (NILP (Vredisplay_preemption_period)) |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3326 force_p = 1; |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3327 else if (!force_p && NUMBERP (Vredisplay_preemption_period)) |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3328 { |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3329 EMACS_TIME tm; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3330 double p = XFLOATINT (Vredisplay_preemption_period); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3331 int sec, usec; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3332 |
71378
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3333 if (detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables ()) |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3334 { |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3335 paused_p = 1; |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3336 goto do_pause; |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3337 } |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3338 |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3339 sec = (int) p; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3340 usec = (p - sec) * 1000000; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3341 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3342 EMACS_GET_TIME (tm); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3343 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (preemption_period, sec, usec); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3344 EMACS_ADD_TIME (preemption_next_check, tm, preemption_period); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3345 } |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3346 #endif |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3347 |
25012 | 3348 if (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)) |
3349 { | |
3350 /* We are working on window matrix basis. All windows whose | |
3351 flag must_be_updated_p is set have to be updated. */ | |
3352 | |
3353 /* Record that we are not working on frame matrices. */ | |
3354 set_frame_matrix_frame (NULL); | |
3355 | |
3356 /* Update all windows in the window tree of F, maybe stopping | |
3357 when pending input is detected. */ | |
3358 update_begin (f); | |
3359 | |
3360 /* Update the menu bar on X frames that don't have toolkit | |
3361 support. */ | |
3362 if (WINDOWP (f->menu_bar_window)) | |
3363 update_window (XWINDOW (f->menu_bar_window), 1); | |
3364 | |
3365 /* Update the tool-bar window, if present. */ | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3366 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
25012 | 3367 { |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3368 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window); |
25012 | 3369 |
3370 /* Update tool-bar window. */ | |
3371 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
3372 { | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3373 Lisp_Object tem; |
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3374 |
25012 | 3375 update_window (w, 1); |
3376 w->must_be_updated_p = 0; | |
3377 | |
3378 /* Swap tool-bar strings. We swap because we want to | |
3379 reuse strings. */ | |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3380 tem = f->current_tool_bar_string; |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3381 f->current_tool_bar_string = f->desired_tool_bar_string; |
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
3382 f->desired_tool_bar_string = tem; |
25012 | 3383 } |
3384 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3385 |
25012 | 3386 |
3387 /* Update windows. */ | |
3388 paused_p = update_window_tree (root_window, force_p); | |
3389 update_end (f); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3390 |
53881
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
3391 /* This flush is a performance bottleneck under X, |
83037 | 3392 and it doesn't seem to be necessary anyway (in general). |
53881
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
3393 It is necessary when resizing the window with the mouse, or |
83037 | 3394 at least the fringes are not redrawn in a timely manner. ++kfs */ |
53881
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
3395 if (f->force_flush_display_p) |
83037 | 3396 { |
3397 FRAME_RIF (f)->flush_display (f); | |
3398 f->force_flush_display_p = 0; | |
3399 } | |
25012 | 3400 } |
3401 else | |
3402 { | |
3403 /* We are working on frame matrix basis. Set the frame on whose | |
3404 frame matrix we operate. */ | |
3405 set_frame_matrix_frame (f); | |
3406 | |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3407 /* Build F's desired matrix from window matrices. */ |
25012 | 3408 build_frame_matrix (f); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3409 |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3410 /* Update the display */ |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3411 update_begin (f); |
25012 | 3412 paused_p = update_frame_1 (f, force_p, inhibit_hairy_id_p); |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3413 update_end (f); |
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3414 |
98508
c370f470d5ba
(update_frame): Flush termscript for MSDOS frames as well as for TTY.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98497
diff
changeset
|
3415 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
3416 { |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
3417 if (FRAME_TTY (f)->termscript) |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
3418 fflush (FRAME_TTY (f)->termscript); |
98508
c370f470d5ba
(update_frame): Flush termscript for MSDOS frames as well as for TTY.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98497
diff
changeset
|
3419 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f)) |
c370f470d5ba
(update_frame): Flush termscript for MSDOS frames as well as for TTY.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98497
diff
changeset
|
3420 fflush (FRAME_TTY (f)->output); |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
3421 } |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3422 |
25012 | 3423 /* Check window matrices for lost pointers. */ |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
3424 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3425 check_window_matrix_pointers (root_window); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3426 add_frame_display_history (f, paused_p); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3427 #endif |
25012 | 3428 } |
3429 | |
111997
a5a188ddc758
Minor clean up to silence some gcc warnings.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
111640
diff
changeset
|
3430 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
71378
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3431 do_pause: |
111997
a5a188ddc758
Minor clean up to silence some gcc warnings.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
111640
diff
changeset
|
3432 #endif |
25012 | 3433 /* Reset flags indicating that a window should be updated. */ |
3434 set_window_update_flags (root_window, 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3435 |
31295
d4f918f0b184
(update_frame): Only set display_completed here; use
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31271
diff
changeset
|
3436 display_completed = !paused_p; |
25012 | 3437 return paused_p; |
3438 } | |
3439 | |
3440 | |
3441 | |
3442 /************************************************************************ | |
3443 Window-based updates | |
3444 ************************************************************************/ | |
3445 | |
3446 /* Perform updates in window tree rooted at W. FORCE_P non-zero means | |
3447 don't stop updating when input is pending. */ | |
3448 | |
3449 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3450 update_window_tree (struct window *w, int force_p) |
25012 | 3451 { |
3452 int paused_p = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3453 |
25012 | 3454 while (w && !paused_p) |
3455 { | |
3456 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) | |
3457 paused_p |= update_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->hchild), force_p); | |
3458 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) | |
3459 paused_p |= update_window_tree (XWINDOW (w->vchild), force_p); | |
3460 else if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
3461 paused_p |= update_window (w, force_p); | |
3462 | |
3463 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); | |
3464 } | |
3465 | |
3466 return paused_p; | |
3467 } | |
3468 | |
3469 | |
3470 /* Update window W if its flag must_be_updated_p is non-zero. If | |
3471 FORCE_P is non-zero, don't stop updating if input is pending. */ | |
3472 | |
3473 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3474 update_single_window (struct window *w, int force_p) |
25012 | 3475 { |
3476 if (w->must_be_updated_p) | |
3477 { | |
3478 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)); | |
3479 | |
3480 /* Record that this is not a frame-based redisplay. */ | |
3481 set_frame_matrix_frame (NULL); | |
3482 | |
76065
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3483 if (redisplay_dont_pause) |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3484 force_p = 1; |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3485 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
76065
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3486 else if (NILP (Vredisplay_preemption_period)) |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3487 force_p = 1; |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3488 else if (!force_p && NUMBERP (Vredisplay_preemption_period)) |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3489 { |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3490 EMACS_TIME tm; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3491 double p = XFLOATINT (Vredisplay_preemption_period); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3492 int sec, usec; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3493 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3494 sec = (int) p; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3495 usec = (p - sec) * 1000000; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3496 |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3497 EMACS_GET_TIME (tm); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3498 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (preemption_period, sec, usec); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3499 EMACS_ADD_TIME (preemption_next_check, tm, preemption_period); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3500 } |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3501 #endif |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3502 |
25012 | 3503 /* Update W. */ |
3504 update_begin (f); | |
3505 update_window (w, force_p); | |
3506 update_end (f); | |
3507 | |
3508 /* Reset flag in W. */ | |
3509 w->must_be_updated_p = 0; | |
3510 } | |
3511 } | |
3512 | |
65905
a82ae68a578e
(redraw_overlapped_rows, redraw_overlapping_rows)
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65890
diff
changeset
|
3513 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
25012 | 3514 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3515 /* Redraw lines from the current matrix of window W that are |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3516 overlapped by other rows. YB is bottom-most y-position in W. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3517 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3518 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3519 redraw_overlapped_rows (struct window *w, int yb) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3520 { |
30165
d7ec5b3caccc
(redraw_overlapped_rows): Add missing local.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30161
diff
changeset
|
3521 int i; |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3522 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3523 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3524 /* If rows overlapping others have been changed, the rows being |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3525 overlapped have to be redrawn. This won't draw lines that have |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3526 already been drawn in update_window_line because overlapped_p in |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3527 desired rows is 0, so after row assignment overlapped_p in |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3528 current rows is 0. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3529 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3530 { |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3531 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows + i; |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3532 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3533 if (!row->enabled_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3534 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3535 else if (row->mode_line_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3536 continue; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3537 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3538 if (row->overlapped_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3539 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3540 enum glyph_row_area area; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3541 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3542 for (area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; area < LAST_AREA; ++area) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3543 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3544 updated_row = row; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3545 updated_area = area; |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3546 FRAME_RIF (f)->cursor_to (i, 0, row->y, |
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3547 area == TEXT_AREA ? row->x : 0); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3548 if (row->used[area]) |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3549 FRAME_RIF (f)->write_glyphs (row->glyphs[area], |
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3550 row->used[area]); |
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3551 FRAME_RIF (f)->clear_end_of_line (-1); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3552 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3553 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3554 row->overlapped_p = 0; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3555 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3556 |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3557 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3558 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3559 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3560 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3561 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3562 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3563 /* Redraw lines from the current matrix of window W that overlap |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3564 others. YB is bottom-most y-position in W. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3565 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3566 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3567 redraw_overlapping_rows (struct window *w, int yb) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3568 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3569 int i, bottom_y; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3570 struct glyph_row *row; |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3571 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3572 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3573 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3574 { |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3575 row = w->current_matrix->rows + i; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3576 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3577 if (!row->enabled_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3578 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3579 else if (row->mode_line_p) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3580 continue; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3581 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3582 bottom_y = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row); |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3583 |
102882
40a6ace09cb5
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Fix detection of
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
101690
diff
changeset
|
3584 if (row->overlapping_p) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3585 { |
65890
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3586 int overlaps = 0; |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3587 |
102882
40a6ace09cb5
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Fix detection of
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
101690
diff
changeset
|
3588 if (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_PRED_P (row) && i > 0 |
65890
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3589 && !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i - 1)->overlapped_p) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3590 overlaps |= OVERLAPS_PRED; |
102882
40a6ace09cb5
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Fix detection of
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
101690
diff
changeset
|
3591 if (MATRIX_ROW_OVERLAPS_SUCC_P (row) && bottom_y < yb |
65890
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3592 && !MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i + 1)->overlapped_p) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3593 overlaps |= OVERLAPS_SUCC; |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3594 |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3595 if (overlaps) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3596 { |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3597 if (row->used[LEFT_MARGIN_AREA]) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3598 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, overlaps); |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3599 |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3600 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3601 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, TEXT_AREA, overlaps); |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3602 |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3603 if (row->used[RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA]) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3604 rif->fix_overlapping_area (w, row, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, overlaps); |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3605 |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3606 /* Record in neighbour rows that ROW overwrites part of |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3607 their display. */ |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3608 if (overlaps & OVERLAPS_PRED) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3609 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i - 1)->overlapped_p = 1; |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3610 if (overlaps & OVERLAPS_SUCC) |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3611 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i + 1)->overlapped_p = 1; |
1a7a619caf97
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Call rif->fix_overlapping_area with new
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
65308
diff
changeset
|
3612 } |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3613 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3614 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3615 if (bottom_y >= yb) |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3616 break; |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3617 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3618 } |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3619 |
65905
a82ae68a578e
(redraw_overlapped_rows, redraw_overlapping_rows)
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65890
diff
changeset
|
3620 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */ |
a82ae68a578e
(redraw_overlapped_rows, redraw_overlapping_rows)
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65890
diff
changeset
|
3621 |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3622 |
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3623 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3624 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3625 /* Check that no row in the current matrix of window W is enabled |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3626 which is below what's displayed in the window. */ |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3627 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3628 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3629 check_current_matrix_flags (struct window *w) |
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3630 { |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3631 int last_seen_p = 0; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3632 int i, yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3633 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3634 for (i = 0; i < w->current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3635 { |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3636 struct glyph_row *row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3637 if (!last_seen_p && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3638 last_seen_p = 1; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3639 else if (last_seen_p && row->enabled_p) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3640 abort (); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3641 } |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3642 } |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3643 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3644 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */ |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3645 |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
3646 |
25012 | 3647 /* Update display of window W. FORCE_P non-zero means that we should |
3648 not stop when detecting pending input. */ | |
3649 | |
3650 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3651 update_window (struct window *w, int force_p) |
25012 | 3652 { |
3653 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
3654 int paused_p; | |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3655 #if !PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
25012 | 3656 int preempt_count = baud_rate / 2400 + 1; |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3657 #endif |
83241
3dcba0bc766b
Merged in changes from CVS trunk. (Long time no see!) :-)
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
diff
changeset
|
3658 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))); |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
3659 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
25012 | 3660 /* Check that W's frame doesn't have glyph matrices. */ |
65308
7b2a711dc863
(window_to_frame_hpos, update_window):
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
65016
diff
changeset
|
3661 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w)))); |
59879
aaf00c303308
* dispnew.c (update_window): Fixing compile error due to
Steven Tamm <steventamm@mac.com>
parents:
59592
diff
changeset
|
3662 #endif |
25012 | 3663 |
3664 /* Check pending input the first time so that we can quickly return. */ | |
76065
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3665 #if !PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
3666 if (!force_p) |
59580
f43d0816e9c3
* keyboard.c (READABLE_EVENTS_DO_TIMERS_NOW)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58986
diff
changeset
|
3667 detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables (); |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3668 #endif |
25012 | 3669 |
3670 /* If forced to complete the update, or if no input is pending, do | |
3671 the update. */ | |
34517
7c8d2cec3d08
(update_window): If do_mouse_tracking is non-nil,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34279
diff
changeset
|
3672 if (force_p || !input_pending || !NILP (do_mouse_tracking)) |
25012 | 3673 { |
3674 struct glyph_row *row, *end; | |
3675 struct glyph_row *mode_line_row; | |
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3676 struct glyph_row *header_line_row; |
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
3677 int yb, changed_p = 0, mouse_face_overwritten_p = 0, n_updated; |
25012 | 3678 |
3679 rif->update_window_begin_hook (w); | |
3680 yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
3681 | |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3682 /* If window has a header line, update it before everything else. |
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3683 Adjust y-positions of other rows by the header line height. */ |
25012 | 3684 row = desired_matrix->rows; |
3685 end = row + desired_matrix->nrows - 1; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3686 |
25012 | 3687 if (row->mode_line_p) |
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3688 { |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3689 header_line_row = row; |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3690 ++row; |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3691 } |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3692 else |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3693 header_line_row = NULL; |
25012 | 3694 |
3695 /* Update the mode line, if necessary. */ | |
3696 mode_line_row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (desired_matrix); | |
3697 if (mode_line_row->mode_line_p && mode_line_row->enabled_p) | |
3698 { | |
3699 mode_line_row->y = yb; | |
3700 update_window_line (w, MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (mode_line_row, | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3701 desired_matrix), |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3702 &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25012 | 3703 } |
3704 | |
3705 /* Find first enabled row. Optimizations in redisplay_internal | |
3706 may lead to an update with only one row enabled. There may | |
3707 be also completely empty matrices. */ | |
3708 while (row < end && !row->enabled_p) | |
3709 ++row; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3710 |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
3711 /* Try reusing part of the display by copying. */ |
25012 | 3712 if (row < end && !desired_matrix->no_scrolling_p) |
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3713 { |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3714 int rc = scrolling_window (w, header_line_row != NULL); |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3715 if (rc < 0) |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3716 { |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3717 /* All rows were found to be equal. */ |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3718 paused_p = 0; |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3719 goto set_cursor; |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3720 } |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3721 else if (rc > 0) |
54847
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
3722 { |
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
3723 /* We've scrolled the display. */ |
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
3724 force_p = 1; |
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
3725 changed_p = 1; |
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
3726 } |
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3727 } |
25012 | 3728 |
3729 /* Update the rest of the lines. */ | |
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
3730 for (n_updated = 0; row < end && (force_p || !input_pending); ++row) |
31653
2554afbeb88d
(update_window): Make sure to make desired rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31295
diff
changeset
|
3731 if (row->enabled_p) |
25012 | 3732 { |
3733 int vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (row, desired_matrix); | |
3734 int i; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3735 |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3736 /* We'll have to play a little bit with when to |
25012 | 3737 detect_input_pending. If it's done too often, |
3738 scrolling large windows with repeated scroll-up | |
3739 commands will too quickly pause redisplay. */ | |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3740 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3741 if (!force_p) |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3742 { |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3743 EMACS_TIME tm, dif; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3744 EMACS_GET_TIME (tm); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3745 EMACS_SUB_TIME (dif, preemption_next_check, tm); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3746 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (dif)) |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3747 { |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3748 EMACS_ADD_TIME (preemption_next_check, tm, preemption_period); |
71378
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3749 if (detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables ()) |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
3750 break; |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3751 } |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3752 } |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3753 #else |
34622
877ed6cab304
(update_window): Detect pending input every nth line
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34517
diff
changeset
|
3754 if (!force_p && ++n_updated % preempt_count == 0) |
59580
f43d0816e9c3
* keyboard.c (READABLE_EVENTS_DO_TIMERS_NOW)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58986
diff
changeset
|
3755 detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables (); |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
3756 #endif |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3757 changed_p |= update_window_line (w, vpos, |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3758 &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25012 | 3759 |
3760 /* Mark all rows below the last visible one in the current | |
3761 matrix as invalid. This is necessary because of | |
3762 variable line heights. Consider the case of three | |
3763 successive redisplays, where the first displays 5 | |
3764 lines, the second 3 lines, and the third 5 lines again. | |
3765 If the second redisplay wouldn't mark rows in the | |
3766 current matrix invalid, the third redisplay might be | |
3767 tempted to optimize redisplay based on lines displayed | |
3768 in the first redisplay. */ | |
3769 if (MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) >= yb) | |
3770 for (i = vpos + 1; i < w->current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) | |
3771 MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, i)->enabled_p = 0; | |
3772 } | |
3773 | |
3774 /* Was display preempted? */ | |
3775 paused_p = row < end; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3776 |
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3777 set_cursor: |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3778 |
54176
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3779 /* Update the header line after scrolling because a new header |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3780 line would otherwise overwrite lines at the top of the window |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3781 that can be scrolled. */ |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3782 if (header_line_row && header_line_row->enabled_p) |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3783 { |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3784 header_line_row->y = 0; |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3785 update_window_line (w, 0, &mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3786 } |
d1e478a807f4
(update_window): Update header line also if there are
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53881
diff
changeset
|
3787 |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
3788 /* Fix the appearance of overlapping/overlapped rows. */ |
25012 | 3789 if (!paused_p && !w->pseudo_window_p) |
3790 { | |
65905
a82ae68a578e
(redraw_overlapped_rows, redraw_overlapping_rows)
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65890
diff
changeset
|
3791 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3792 if (changed_p && rif->fix_overlapping_area) |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3793 { |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3794 redraw_overlapped_rows (w, yb); |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3795 redraw_overlapping_rows (w, yb); |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3796 } |
65905
a82ae68a578e
(redraw_overlapped_rows, redraw_overlapping_rows)
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65890
diff
changeset
|
3797 #endif |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3798 |
25012 | 3799 /* Make cursor visible at cursor position of W. */ |
3800 set_window_cursor_after_update (w); | |
3801 | |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3802 #if 0 /* Check that current matrix invariants are satisfied. This is |
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
3803 for debugging only. See the comment of check_matrix_invariants. */ |
25012 | 3804 IF_DEBUG (check_matrix_invariants (w)); |
3805 #endif | |
3806 } | |
3807 | |
3808 #if GLYPH_DEBUG | |
3809 /* Remember the redisplay method used to display the matrix. */ | |
3810 strcpy (w->current_matrix->method, w->desired_matrix->method); | |
3811 #endif | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3812 |
53612
2ddd2a0d047a
Revision: miles@gnu.org--gnu-2004/emacs--cvs-trunk--0--patch-41
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
53605
diff
changeset
|
3813 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
3814 update_window_fringes (w, 0); |
53612
2ddd2a0d047a
Revision: miles@gnu.org--gnu-2004/emacs--cvs-trunk--0--patch-41
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
53605
diff
changeset
|
3815 #endif |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
3816 |
38489
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3817 /* End the update of window W. Don't set the cursor if we |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3818 paused updating the display because in this case, |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3819 set_window_cursor_after_update hasn't been called, and |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3820 output_cursor doesn't contain the cursor location. */ |
19cb32759a2a
(update_window): Don't set the cursor at the end
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
38354
diff
changeset
|
3821 rif->update_window_end_hook (w, !paused_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p); |
25012 | 3822 } |
3823 else | |
3824 paused_p = 1; | |
3825 | |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
3826 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
34944
4fc804373f2a
(update_window): Don't check_current_matrix_flags.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34929
diff
changeset
|
3827 /* check_current_matrix_flags (w); */ |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3828 add_window_display_history (w, w->current_matrix->method, paused_p); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
3829 #endif |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3830 |
25012 | 3831 clear_glyph_matrix (desired_matrix); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3832 |
25012 | 3833 return paused_p; |
3834 } | |
3835 | |
3836 | |
3837 /* Update the display of area AREA in window W, row number VPOS. | |
3838 AREA can be either LEFT_MARGIN_AREA or RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA. */ | |
3839 | |
3840 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3841 update_marginal_area (struct window *w, int area, int vpos) |
25012 | 3842 { |
3843 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3844 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))); |
25012 | 3845 |
3846 /* Let functions in xterm.c know what area subsequent X positions | |
3847 will be relative to. */ | |
3848 updated_area = area; | |
3849 | |
3850 /* Set cursor to start of glyphs, write them, and clear to the end | |
3851 of the area. I don't think that something more sophisticated is | |
3852 necessary here, since marginal areas will not be the default. */ | |
3853 rif->cursor_to (vpos, 0, desired_row->y, 0); | |
3854 if (desired_row->used[area]) | |
3855 rif->write_glyphs (desired_row->glyphs[area], desired_row->used[area]); | |
3856 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
3857 } | |
3858 | |
3859 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3860 /* Update the display of the text area of row VPOS in window W. |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3861 Value is non-zero if display has changed. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3862 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3863 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3864 update_text_area (struct window *w, int vpos) |
314 | 3865 { |
25012 | 3866 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos); |
3867 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
3868 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3869 int changed_p = 0; |
25012 | 3870 |
3871 /* Let functions in xterm.c know what area subsequent X positions | |
3872 will be relative to. */ | |
3873 updated_area = TEXT_AREA; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3874 |
25012 | 3875 /* If rows are at different X or Y, or rows have different height, |
3876 or the current row is marked invalid, write the entire line. */ | |
3877 if (!current_row->enabled_p | |
3878 || desired_row->y != current_row->y | |
3879 || desired_row->ascent != current_row->ascent | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3880 || desired_row->phys_ascent != current_row->phys_ascent |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3881 || desired_row->phys_height != current_row->phys_height |
25012 | 3882 || desired_row->visible_height != current_row->visible_height |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3883 || current_row->overlapped_p |
75371
7267980a2f42
* dispnew.c (update_text_area): Revert 2006-09-17 change.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
3884 /* This next line is necessary for correctly redrawing |
7267980a2f42
* dispnew.c (update_text_area): Revert 2006-09-17 change.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
3885 mouse-face areas after scrolling and other operations. |
7267980a2f42
* dispnew.c (update_text_area): Revert 2006-09-17 change.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
3886 However, it causes excessive flickering when mouse is moved |
7267980a2f42
* dispnew.c (update_text_area): Revert 2006-09-17 change.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
3887 across the mode line. Luckily, turning it off for the mode |
76069
898ccefda9ce
(update_text_area): Clear mouse face on header lines.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
76065
diff
changeset
|
3888 line doesn't seem to hurt anything. -- cyd. |
898ccefda9ce
(update_text_area): Clear mouse face on header lines.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
76065
diff
changeset
|
3889 But it is still needed for the header line. -- kfs. */ |
898ccefda9ce
(update_text_area): Clear mouse face on header lines.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
76065
diff
changeset
|
3890 || (current_row->mouse_face_p |
898ccefda9ce
(update_text_area): Clear mouse face on header lines.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
76065
diff
changeset
|
3891 && !(current_row->mode_line_p && vpos > 0)) |
25012 | 3892 || current_row->x != desired_row->x) |
3893 { | |
3894 rif->cursor_to (vpos, 0, desired_row->y, desired_row->x); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3895 |
25012 | 3896 if (desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
3897 rif->write_glyphs (desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA], | |
3898 desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3899 |
25012 | 3900 /* Clear to end of window. */ |
3901 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
3902 changed_p = 1; |
44815
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3903 |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3904 /* This erases the cursor. We do this here because |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3905 notice_overwritten_cursor cannot easily check this, which |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3906 might indicate that the whole functionality of |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3907 notice_overwritten_cursor would better be implemented here. |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3908 On the other hand, we need notice_overwritten_cursor as long |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3909 as mouse highlighting is done asynchronously outside of |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3910 redisplay. */ |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3911 if (vpos == w->phys_cursor.vpos) |
cf2454d3a103
(update_text_area): Set phys_cursor_on_p to 0 in the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44580
diff
changeset
|
3912 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0; |
25012 | 3913 } |
3914 else | |
3915 { | |
3916 int stop, i, x; | |
3917 struct glyph *current_glyph = current_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
3918 struct glyph *desired_glyph = desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3919 int overlapping_glyphs_p = current_row->contains_overlapping_glyphs_p; |
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
3920 int desired_stop_pos = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; |
98589
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3921 int abort_skipping = 0; |
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
3922 |
69110
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3923 /* If the desired row extends its face to the text area end, and |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3924 unless the current row also does so at the same position, |
25012 | 3925 make sure we write at least one glyph, so that the face |
3926 extension actually takes place. */ | |
69110
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3927 if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (desired_row) |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3928 && (desired_stop_pos < current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3929 || (desired_stop_pos == current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3930 && !MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (current_row)))) |
35268
d93bf580d166
(update_text_area): Put code which decrements the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35006
diff
changeset
|
3931 --desired_stop_pos; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3932 |
25012 | 3933 stop = min (current_row->used[TEXT_AREA], desired_stop_pos); |
3934 i = 0; | |
3935 x = desired_row->x; | |
36097
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
3936 |
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
3937 /* Loop over glyphs that current and desired row may have |
1dfaaf6d6166
(update_text_area): Undo change of 2001-01-12.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35924
diff
changeset
|
3938 in common. */ |
25012 | 3939 while (i < stop) |
3940 { | |
98589
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3941 int can_skip_p = !abort_skipping; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3942 |
25012 | 3943 /* Skip over glyphs that both rows have in common. These |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3944 don't have to be written. We can't skip if the last |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3945 current glyph overlaps the glyph to its right. For |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3946 example, consider a current row of `if ' with the `f' in |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3947 Courier bold so that it overlaps the ` ' to its right. |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3948 If the desired row is ` ', we would skip over the space |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3949 after the `if' and there would remain a pixel from the |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3950 `f' on the screen. */ |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3951 if (overlapping_glyphs_p && i > 0) |
25012 | 3952 { |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3953 struct glyph *glyph = ¤t_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][i - 1]; |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3954 int left, right; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3955 |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3956 rif->get_glyph_overhangs (glyph, XFRAME (w->frame), |
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
3957 &left, &right); |
98589
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3958 can_skip_p = (right == 0 && !abort_skipping); |
25012 | 3959 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3960 |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3961 if (can_skip_p) |
25012 | 3962 { |
98589
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3963 int start_hpos = i; |
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3964 |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3965 while (i < stop |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3966 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (desired_glyph, current_glyph)) |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3967 { |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3968 x += desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3969 ++desired_glyph, ++current_glyph, ++i; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3970 } |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3971 |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3972 /* Consider the case that the current row contains "xxx |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3973 ppp ggg" in italic Courier font, and the desired row |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3974 is "xxx ggg". The character `p' has lbearing, `g' |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3975 has not. The loop above will stop in front of the |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3976 first `p' in the current row. If we would start |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3977 writing glyphs there, we wouldn't erase the lbearing |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3978 of the `p'. The rest of the lbearing problem is then |
50218
06f75553f0a4
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Use enum
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3979 taken care of by draw_glyphs. */ |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3980 if (overlapping_glyphs_p |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3981 && i > 0 |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3982 && i < current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3983 && (current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3984 != desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA])) |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3985 { |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3986 int left, right; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
3987 |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3988 rif->get_glyph_overhangs (current_glyph, XFRAME (w->frame), |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3989 &left, &right); |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3990 while (left > 0 && i > 0) |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3991 { |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3992 --i, --desired_glyph, --current_glyph; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3993 x -= desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3994 left -= desired_glyph->pixel_width; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
3995 } |
98589
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3996 |
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3997 /* Abort the skipping algorithm if we end up before |
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3998 our starting point, to avoid looping (bug#1070). |
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
3999 This can happen when the lbearing is larger than |
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
4000 the pixel width. */ |
b4502c55e86b
(update_text_area): Avoid looping due to large glyph
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98508
diff
changeset
|
4001 abort_skipping = (i < start_hpos); |
25012 | 4002 } |
4003 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4004 |
25012 | 4005 /* Try to avoid writing the entire rest of the desired row |
4006 by looking for a resync point. This mainly prevents | |
4007 mode line flickering in the case the mode line is in | |
4008 fixed-pitch font, which it usually will be. */ | |
4009 if (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4010 { | |
4011 int start_x = x, start_hpos = i; | |
4012 struct glyph *start = desired_glyph; | |
4013 int current_x = x; | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4014 int skip_first_p = !can_skip_p; |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4015 |
25012 | 4016 /* Find the next glyph that's equal again. */ |
4017 while (i < stop | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4018 && (skip_first_p |
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4019 || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (desired_glyph, current_glyph)) |
25012 | 4020 && x == current_x) |
4021 { | |
4022 x += desired_glyph->pixel_width; | |
4023 current_x += current_glyph->pixel_width; | |
4024 ++desired_glyph, ++current_glyph, ++i; | |
33603
6697403d3c12
(update_text_area): Fix last change.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33596
diff
changeset
|
4025 skip_first_p = 0; |
25012 | 4026 } |
4027 | |
4028 if (i == start_hpos || x != current_x) | |
4029 { | |
4030 i = start_hpos; | |
4031 x = start_x; | |
4032 desired_glyph = start; | |
4033 break; | |
4034 } | |
33596
680ddd4ab1f9
(update_text_area): Don't skip over equal glyphs
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33527
diff
changeset
|
4035 |
25012 | 4036 rif->cursor_to (vpos, start_hpos, desired_row->y, start_x); |
4037 rif->write_glyphs (start, i - start_hpos); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4038 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4039 } |
4040 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4041 |
25012 | 4042 /* Write the rest. */ |
4043 if (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4044 { | |
4045 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, x); | |
4046 rif->write_glyphs (desired_glyph, desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - i); | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4047 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4048 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4049 |
25012 | 4050 /* Maybe clear to end of line. */ |
4051 if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (desired_row)) | |
4052 { | |
4053 /* If new row extends to the end of the text area, nothing | |
4054 has to be cleared, if and only if we did a write_glyphs | |
4055 above. This is made sure by setting desired_stop_pos | |
4056 appropriately above. */ | |
69110
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
4057 xassert (i < desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
4058 || ((desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
4059 == current_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
9d86d35acf33
(update_text_area): Avoid needless redraw of rightmost
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
4060 && MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (current_row))); |
25012 | 4061 } |
4062 else if (MATRIX_ROW_EXTENDS_FACE_P (current_row)) | |
4063 { | |
4064 /* If old row extends to the end of the text area, clear. */ | |
4065 if (i >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) | |
4066 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, | |
53055
4cb0d5b004e9
(update_text_area): Fix redisplay error when hscroll
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
4067 desired_row->pixel_width); |
25012 | 4068 rif->clear_end_of_line (-1); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4069 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4070 } |
4071 else if (desired_row->pixel_width < current_row->pixel_width) | |
4072 { | |
4073 /* Otherwise clear to the end of the old row. Everything | |
4074 after that position should be clear already. */ | |
4075 int x; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4076 |
25012 | 4077 if (i >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
4078 rif->cursor_to (vpos, i, desired_row->y, | |
53055
4cb0d5b004e9
(update_text_area): Fix redisplay error when hscroll
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
4079 desired_row->pixel_width); |
25012 | 4080 |
4081 /* If cursor is displayed at the end of the line, make sure | |
4082 it's cleared. Nowadays we don't have a phys_cursor_glyph | |
4083 with which to erase the cursor (because this method | |
4084 doesn't work with lbearing/rbearing), so we must do it | |
4085 this way. */ | |
4086 if (vpos == w->phys_cursor.vpos | |
107991
74557d25410e
Implement cursor on the left fringe for R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107737
diff
changeset
|
4087 && (desired_row->reversed_p |
74557d25410e
Implement cursor on the left fringe for R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107737
diff
changeset
|
4088 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0) |
74557d25410e
Implement cursor on the left fringe for R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107737
diff
changeset
|
4089 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]))) |
25012 | 4090 { |
4091 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 0; | |
4092 x = -1; | |
4093 } | |
4094 else | |
53055
4cb0d5b004e9
(update_text_area): Fix redisplay error when hscroll
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
4095 x = current_row->pixel_width; |
25012 | 4096 rif->clear_end_of_line (x); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4097 changed_p = 1; |
25012 | 4098 } |
4099 } | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4100 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4101 return changed_p; |
25012 | 4102 } |
4103 | |
4104 | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4105 /* Update row VPOS in window W. Value is non-zero if display has been |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4106 changed. */ |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4107 |
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4108 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4109 update_window_line (struct window *w, int vpos, int *mouse_face_overwritten_p) |
25012 | 4110 { |
4111 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, vpos); | |
4112 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (w->desired_matrix, vpos); | |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
4113 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4114 int changed_p = 0; |
25012 | 4115 |
4116 /* Set the row being updated. This is important to let xterm.c | |
4117 know what line height values are in effect. */ | |
4118 updated_row = desired_row; | |
4119 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4120 /* A row can be completely invisible in case a desired matrix was |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4121 built with a vscroll and then make_cursor_line_fully_visible shifts |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4122 the matrix. Make sure to make such rows current anyway, since |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4123 we need the correct y-position, for example, in the current matrix. */ |
31726
59b455472b56
(update_window_line): Make sure to always draw
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31690
diff
changeset
|
4124 if (desired_row->mode_line_p |
59b455472b56
(update_window_line): Make sure to always draw
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31690
diff
changeset
|
4125 || desired_row->visible_height > 0) |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4126 { |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4127 xassert (desired_row->enabled_p); |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4128 |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4129 /* Update display of the left margin area, if there is one. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4130 if (!desired_row->full_width_p |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4131 && !NILP (w->left_margin_cols)) |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4132 { |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4133 changed_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4134 update_marginal_area (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA, vpos); |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4135 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4136 |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4137 /* Update the display of the text area. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4138 if (update_text_area (w, vpos)) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4139 { |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4140 changed_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4141 if (current_row->mouse_face_p) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4142 *mouse_face_overwritten_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4143 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4144 |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4145 /* Update display of the right margin area, if there is one. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4146 if (!desired_row->full_width_p |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4147 && !NILP (w->right_margin_cols)) |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4148 { |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4149 changed_p = 1; |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4150 update_marginal_area (w, RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA, vpos); |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4151 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4152 |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4153 /* Draw truncation marks etc. */ |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4154 if (!current_row->enabled_p |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4155 || desired_row->y != current_row->y |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4156 || desired_row->visible_height != current_row->visible_height |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4157 || desired_row->cursor_in_fringe_p != current_row->cursor_in_fringe_p |
61633
a76a30ee7c89
(row_equal_p, update_window_line, scrolling_window):
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
61416
diff
changeset
|
4158 || desired_row->overlay_arrow_bitmap != current_row->overlay_arrow_bitmap |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4159 || current_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4160 || desired_row->mode_line_p != current_row->mode_line_p |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4161 || desired_row->exact_window_width_line_p != current_row->exact_window_width_line_p |
31690
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4162 || (MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (desired_row) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4163 != MATRIX_ROW_CONTINUATION_LINE_P (current_row))) |
6abff42174ea
(update_window): Move test for invisible lines
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31653
diff
changeset
|
4164 rif->after_update_window_line_hook (desired_row); |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4165 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4166 |
25012 | 4167 /* Update current_row from desired_row. */ |
4168 make_current (w->desired_matrix, w->current_matrix, vpos); | |
4169 updated_row = NULL; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4170 return changed_p; |
25012 | 4171 } |
4172 | |
4173 | |
4174 /* Set the cursor after an update of window W. This function may only | |
4175 be called from update_window. */ | |
4176 | |
4177 static void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4178 set_window_cursor_after_update (struct window *w) |
25012 | 4179 { |
4180 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame); | |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
4181 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (f); |
25012 | 4182 int cx, cy, vpos, hpos; |
4183 | |
4184 /* Not intended for frame matrix updates. */ | |
4185 xassert (FRAME_WINDOW_P (f)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4186 |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4187 if (cursor_in_echo_area |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4188 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]) |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4189 /* If we are showing a message instead of the mini-buffer, |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4190 show the cursor for the message instead. */ |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4191 && XWINDOW (minibuf_window) == w |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4192 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window) |
25012 | 4193 /* These cases apply only to the frame that contains |
4194 the active mini-buffer window. */ | |
4195 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) | |
4196 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window)) | |
4197 { | |
4198 cx = cy = vpos = hpos = 0; | |
4199 | |
4200 if (cursor_in_echo_area >= 0) | |
4201 { | |
4202 /* If the mini-buffer is several lines high, find the last | |
4203 line that has any text on it. Note: either all lines | |
4204 are enabled or none. Otherwise we wouldn't be able to | |
4205 determine Y. */ | |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4206 struct glyph_row *row, *last_row; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4207 struct glyph *glyph; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4208 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4209 |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4210 last_row = NULL; |
39254
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4211 row = w->current_matrix->rows; |
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4212 while (row->enabled_p |
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4213 && (last_row == NULL |
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4214 || MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row) <= yb)) |
25012 | 4215 { |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4216 if (row->used[TEXT_AREA] |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4217 && row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA][0].charpos >= 0) |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4218 last_row = row; |
39254
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4219 ++row; |
25012 | 4220 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4221 |
25012 | 4222 if (last_row) |
4223 { | |
39254
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4224 struct glyph *start = last_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
73dd40615520
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Fix code
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39226
diff
changeset
|
4225 struct glyph *last = start + last_row->used[TEXT_AREA] - 1; |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4226 |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4227 while (last > start && last->charpos < 0) |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4228 --last; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4229 |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4230 for (glyph = start; glyph < last; ++glyph) |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4231 { |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4232 cx += glyph->pixel_width; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4233 ++hpos; |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4234 } |
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4235 |
25012 | 4236 cy = last_row->y; |
25190
a14edd4a5f4a
(set_window_cursor_after_update): Correct cursor
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25186
diff
changeset
|
4237 vpos = MATRIX_ROW_VPOS (last_row, w->current_matrix); |
25012 | 4238 } |
4239 } | |
4240 } | |
4241 else | |
4242 { | |
4243 cx = w->cursor.x; | |
4244 cy = w->cursor.y; | |
4245 hpos = w->cursor.hpos; | |
4246 vpos = w->cursor.vpos; | |
4247 } | |
4248 | |
4249 /* Window cursor can be out of sync for horizontally split windows. */ | |
107991
74557d25410e
Implement cursor on the left fringe for R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
107737
diff
changeset
|
4250 hpos = max (-1, hpos); /* -1 is for when cursor is on the left fringe */ |
25012 | 4251 hpos = min (w->current_matrix->matrix_w - 1, hpos); |
4252 vpos = max (0, vpos); | |
4253 vpos = min (w->current_matrix->nrows - 1, vpos); | |
4254 rif->cursor_to (vpos, hpos, cy, cx); | |
4255 } | |
4256 | |
4257 | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4258 /* Set WINDOW->must_be_updated_p to ON_P for all windows in the window |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4259 tree rooted at W. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4260 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4261 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4262 set_window_update_flags (struct window *w, int on_p) |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4263 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4264 while (w) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4265 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4266 if (!NILP (w->hchild)) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4267 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (w->hchild), on_p); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4268 else if (!NILP (w->vchild)) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4269 set_window_update_flags (XWINDOW (w->vchild), on_p); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4270 else |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4271 w->must_be_updated_p = on_p; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4272 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4273 w = NILP (w->next) ? 0 : XWINDOW (w->next); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4274 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4275 } |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4276 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4277 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4278 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4279 /*********************************************************************** |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4280 Window-Based Scrolling |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4281 ***********************************************************************/ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4282 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4283 /* Structure describing rows in scrolling_window. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4284 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4285 struct row_entry |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4286 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4287 /* Number of occurrences of this row in desired and current matrix. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4288 int old_uses, new_uses; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4289 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4290 /* Vpos of row in new matrix. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4291 int new_line_number; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4292 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4293 /* Bucket index of this row_entry in the hash table row_table. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4294 int bucket; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4295 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4296 /* The row described by this entry. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4297 struct glyph_row *row; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4298 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4299 /* Hash collision chain. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4300 struct row_entry *next; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4301 }; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4302 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4303 /* A pool to allocate row_entry structures from, and the size of the |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4304 pool. The pool is reallocated in scrolling_window when we find |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4305 that we need a larger one. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4306 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4307 static struct row_entry *row_entry_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4308 static int row_entry_pool_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4309 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4310 /* Index of next free entry in row_entry_pool. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4311 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4312 static int row_entry_idx; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4313 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4314 /* The hash table used during scrolling, and the table's size. This |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4315 table is used to quickly identify equal rows in the desired and |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4316 current matrix. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4317 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4318 static struct row_entry **row_table; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4319 static int row_table_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4320 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4321 /* Vectors of pointers to row_entry structures belonging to the |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4322 current and desired matrix, and the size of the vectors. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4323 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4324 static struct row_entry **old_lines, **new_lines; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4325 static int old_lines_size, new_lines_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4326 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4327 /* A pool to allocate run structures from, and its size. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4328 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4329 static struct run *run_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4330 static int runs_size; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4331 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4332 /* A vector of runs of lines found during scrolling. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4333 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4334 static struct run **runs; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4335 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4336 /* Add glyph row ROW to the scrolling hash table during the scrolling |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4337 of window W. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4338 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4339 static INLINE struct row_entry * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4340 add_row_entry (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row) |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4341 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4342 struct row_entry *entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4343 int i = row->hash % row_table_size; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4344 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4345 entry = row_table[i]; |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
4346 while (entry && !row_equal_p (w, entry->row, row, 1)) |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4347 entry = entry->next; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4348 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4349 if (entry == NULL) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4350 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4351 entry = row_entry_pool + row_entry_idx++; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4352 entry->row = row; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4353 entry->old_uses = entry->new_uses = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4354 entry->new_line_number = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4355 entry->bucket = i; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4356 entry->next = row_table[i]; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4357 row_table[i] = entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4358 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4359 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4360 return entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4361 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4362 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4363 |
25012 | 4364 /* Try to reuse part of the current display of W by scrolling lines. |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
4365 HEADER_LINE_P non-zero means W has a header line. |
25012 | 4366 |
4367 The algorithm is taken from Communications of the ACM, Apr78 "A | |
4368 Technique for Isolating Differences Between Files." It should take | |
4369 O(N) time. | |
4370 | |
4371 A short outline of the steps of the algorithm | |
4372 | |
4373 1. Skip lines equal at the start and end of both matrices. | |
4374 | |
4375 2. Enter rows in the current and desired matrix into a symbol | |
4376 table, counting how often they appear in both matrices. | |
4377 | |
4378 3. Rows that appear exactly once in both matrices serve as anchors, | |
4379 i.e. we assume that such lines are likely to have been moved. | |
4380 | |
4381 4. Starting from anchor lines, extend regions to be scrolled both | |
4382 forward and backward. | |
4383 | |
4384 Value is | |
4385 | |
4386 -1 if all rows were found to be equal. | |
4387 0 to indicate that we did not scroll the display, or | |
4388 1 if we did scroll. */ | |
4389 | |
4390 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4391 scrolling_window (struct window *w, int header_line_p) |
25012 | 4392 { |
4393 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = w->desired_matrix; | |
4394 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = w->current_matrix; | |
4395 int yb = window_text_bottom_y (w); | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4396 int i, j, first_old, first_new, last_old, last_new; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4397 int nruns, nbytes, n, run_idx; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4398 struct row_entry *entry; |
82992
5de4189e659d
Got rid of the rif (window-based redisplay interface) global variable.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82990
diff
changeset
|
4399 struct redisplay_interface *rif = FRAME_RIF (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w))); |
25012 | 4400 |
4401 /* Skip over rows equal at the start. */ | |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4402 for (i = header_line_p ? 1 : 0; i < current_matrix->nrows - 1; ++i) |
25012 | 4403 { |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4404 struct glyph_row *d = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i); |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4405 struct glyph_row *c = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i); |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4406 |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4407 if (c->enabled_p |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4408 && d->enabled_p |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4409 && !d->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p |
31825
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4410 && c->y == d->y |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4411 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (c) <= yb |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4412 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (d) <= yb |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4413 && row_equal_p (w, c, d, 1)) |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4414 { |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4415 assign_row (c, d); |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4416 d->enabled_p = 0; |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4417 } |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4418 else |
62830644b967
(scrolling_window): Compare y-positions of rows
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
31726
diff
changeset
|
4419 break; |
25012 | 4420 } |
4421 | |
4422 /* Give up if some rows in the desired matrix are not enabled. */ | |
4423 if (!MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
4424 return -1; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4425 |
25012 | 4426 first_old = first_new = i; |
4427 | |
4428 /* Set last_new to the index + 1 of the last enabled row in the | |
4429 desired matrix. */ | |
4430 i = first_new + 1; | |
4431 while (i < desired_matrix->nrows - 1 | |
4432 && MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4433 && MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)) <= yb) |
25012 | 4434 ++i; |
4435 | |
4436 if (!MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
4437 return 0; | |
4438 | |
4439 last_new = i; | |
4440 | |
4441 /* Set last_old to the index + 1 of the last enabled row in the | |
4442 current matrix. We don't look at the enabled flag here because | |
4443 we plan to reuse part of the display even if other parts are | |
4444 disabled. */ | |
4445 i = first_old + 1; | |
34929
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4446 while (i < current_matrix->nrows - 1) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4447 { |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4448 int bottom = MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4449 if (bottom <= yb) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4450 ++i; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4451 if (bottom >= yb) |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4452 break; |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4453 } |
b116257b3b28
(check_current_matrix_flags) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34895
diff
changeset
|
4454 |
25012 | 4455 last_old = i; |
4456 | |
4457 /* Skip over rows equal at the bottom. */ | |
4458 i = last_new; | |
4459 j = last_old; | |
4460 while (i - 1 > first_new | |
4461 && j - 1 > first_old | |
4462 && MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i - 1)->enabled_p | |
4463 && (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i - 1)->y | |
4464 == MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, j - 1)->y) | |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4465 && !MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, j - 1)->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p |
25012 | 4466 && row_equal_p (w, |
4467 MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i - 1), | |
30152
f6270e5282da
(direct_output_forward_char): Give up if currently
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30041
diff
changeset
|
4468 MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j - 1), 1)) |
25012 | 4469 --i, --j; |
4470 last_new = i; | |
4471 last_old = j; | |
4472 | |
4473 /* Nothing to do if all rows are equal. */ | |
4474 if (last_new == first_new) | |
4475 return 0; | |
4476 | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4477 /* Reallocate vectors, tables etc. if necessary. */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4478 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4479 if (current_matrix->nrows > old_lines_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4480 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4481 old_lines_size = current_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4482 nbytes = old_lines_size * sizeof *old_lines; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4483 old_lines = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (old_lines, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4484 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4485 |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4486 if (desired_matrix->nrows > new_lines_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4487 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4488 new_lines_size = desired_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4489 nbytes = new_lines_size * sizeof *new_lines; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4490 new_lines = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (new_lines, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4491 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4492 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4493 n = desired_matrix->nrows + current_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4494 if (3 * n > row_table_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4495 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4496 row_table_size = next_almost_prime (3 * n); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4497 nbytes = row_table_size * sizeof *row_table; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4498 row_table = (struct row_entry **) xrealloc (row_table, nbytes); |
109165
750db9f3e6d8
Replace bcopy, bzero, bcmp by memcpy, memmove, memset, memcmp
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
4499 memset (row_table, 0, nbytes); |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4500 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4501 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4502 if (n > row_entry_pool_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4503 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4504 row_entry_pool_size = n; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4505 nbytes = row_entry_pool_size * sizeof *row_entry_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4506 row_entry_pool = (struct row_entry *) xrealloc (row_entry_pool, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4507 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4508 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4509 if (desired_matrix->nrows > runs_size) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4510 { |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4511 runs_size = desired_matrix->nrows; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4512 nbytes = runs_size * sizeof *runs; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4513 runs = (struct run **) xrealloc (runs, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4514 nbytes = runs_size * sizeof *run_pool; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4515 run_pool = (struct run *) xrealloc (run_pool, nbytes); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4516 } |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4517 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4518 nruns = run_idx = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4519 row_entry_idx = 0; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4520 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4521 /* Add rows from the current and desired matrix to the hash table |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4522 row_hash_table to be able to find equal ones quickly. */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4523 |
25012 | 4524 for (i = first_old; i < last_old; ++i) |
4525 { | |
4526 if (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->enabled_p) | |
4527 { | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4528 entry = add_row_entry (w, MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4529 old_lines[i] = entry; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4530 ++entry->old_uses; |
25012 | 4531 } |
4532 else | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4533 old_lines[i] = NULL; |
25012 | 4534 } |
4535 | |
4536 for (i = first_new; i < last_new; ++i) | |
4537 { | |
4538 xassert (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)); | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4539 entry = add_row_entry (w, MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)); |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4540 ++entry->new_uses; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4541 entry->new_line_number = i; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4542 new_lines[i] = entry; |
25012 | 4543 } |
4544 | |
4545 /* Identify moves based on lines that are unique and equal | |
4546 in both matrices. */ | |
4547 for (i = first_old; i < last_old;) | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4548 if (old_lines[i] |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4549 && old_lines[i]->old_uses == 1 |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4550 && old_lines[i]->new_uses == 1) |
25012 | 4551 { |
4552 int j, k; | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4553 int new_line = old_lines[i]->new_line_number; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4554 struct run *run = run_pool + run_idx++; |
25012 | 4555 |
4556 /* Record move. */ | |
4557 run->current_vpos = i; | |
4558 run->current_y = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->y; | |
4559 run->desired_vpos = new_line; | |
4560 run->desired_y = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, new_line)->y; | |
4561 run->nrows = 1; | |
4562 run->height = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)->height; | |
4563 | |
4564 /* Extend backward. */ | |
4565 j = i - 1; | |
4566 k = new_line - 1; | |
4567 while (j > first_old | |
4568 && k > first_new | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4569 && old_lines[j] == new_lines[k]) |
25012 | 4570 { |
4571 int h = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j)->height; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4572 --run->current_vpos; |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4573 --run->desired_vpos; |
25012 | 4574 ++run->nrows; |
4575 run->height += h; | |
4576 run->desired_y -= h; | |
4577 run->current_y -= h; | |
4578 --j, --k; | |
4579 } | |
4580 | |
4581 /* Extend forward. */ | |
4582 j = i + 1; | |
4583 k = new_line + 1; | |
4584 while (j < last_old | |
4585 && k < last_new | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4586 && old_lines[j] == new_lines[k]) |
25012 | 4587 { |
4588 int h = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, j)->height; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4589 ++run->nrows; |
25012 | 4590 run->height += h; |
4591 ++j, ++k; | |
4592 } | |
4593 | |
4594 /* Insert run into list of all runs. Order runs by copied | |
4595 pixel lines. Note that we record runs that don't have to | |
4596 be copied because they are already in place. This is done | |
4597 because we can avoid calling update_window_line in this | |
4598 case. */ | |
4599 for (j = 0; j < nruns && runs[j]->height > run->height; ++j) | |
4600 ; | |
34203
e55480843a8e
(scrolling_window): Fix code inserting runs in list of all runs.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
33763
diff
changeset
|
4601 for (k = nruns; k > j; --k) |
25012 | 4602 runs[k] = runs[k - 1]; |
4603 runs[j] = run; | |
4604 ++nruns; | |
4605 | |
4606 i += run->nrows; | |
4607 } | |
4608 else | |
4609 ++i; | |
4610 | |
4611 /* Do the moves. Do it in a way that we don't overwrite something | |
4612 we want to copy later on. This is not solvable in general | |
4613 because there is only one display and we don't have a way to | |
4614 exchange areas on this display. Example: | |
4615 | |
4616 +-----------+ +-----------+ | |
4617 | A | | B | | |
4618 +-----------+ --> +-----------+ | |
4619 | B | | A | | |
4620 +-----------+ +-----------+ | |
4621 | |
4622 Instead, prefer bigger moves, and invalidate moves that would | |
4623 copy from where we copied to. */ | |
4624 | |
4625 for (i = 0; i < nruns; ++i) | |
4626 if (runs[i]->nrows > 0) | |
4627 { | |
4628 struct run *r = runs[i]; | |
4629 | |
4630 /* Copy on the display. */ | |
4631 if (r->current_y != r->desired_y) | |
4632 { | |
4633 rif->scroll_run_hook (w, r); | |
4634 | |
4635 /* Invalidate runs that copy from where we copied to. */ | |
4636 for (j = i + 1; j < nruns; ++j) | |
4637 { | |
4638 struct run *p = runs[j]; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4639 |
25012 | 4640 if ((p->current_y >= r->desired_y |
4641 && p->current_y < r->desired_y + r->height) | |
4642 || (p->current_y + p->height >= r->desired_y | |
4643 && (p->current_y + p->height | |
4644 < r->desired_y + r->height))) | |
4645 p->nrows = 0; | |
4646 } | |
4647 } | |
4648 | |
4649 /* Assign matrix rows. */ | |
4650 for (j = 0; j < r->nrows; ++j) | |
4651 { | |
4652 struct glyph_row *from, *to; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4653 int to_overlapped_p; |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4654 |
25012 | 4655 to = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, r->desired_vpos + j); |
30161
8be2bf27e9ad
(make_current): Preserve the mouse_face_p flag of the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30152
diff
changeset
|
4656 from = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, r->desired_vpos + j); |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4657 to_overlapped_p = to->overlapped_p; |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4658 if (!from->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p |
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4659 && (to->left_fringe_bitmap != from->left_fringe_bitmap |
53881
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
4660 || to->right_fringe_bitmap != from->right_fringe_bitmap |
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
4661 || to->left_fringe_face_id != from->left_fringe_face_id |
ccacbf7f76b2
(row_equal_p): Compare fringe bitmap faces and overlay
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53612
diff
changeset
|
4662 || to->right_fringe_face_id != from->right_fringe_face_id |
61633
a76a30ee7c89
(row_equal_p, update_window_line, scrolling_window):
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
61416
diff
changeset
|
4663 || to->overlay_arrow_bitmap != from->overlay_arrow_bitmap)) |
53605
7dfd96e25ec6
(row_equal_p, update_window_line): Compare fringe bitmaps
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53514
diff
changeset
|
4664 from->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1; |
25012 | 4665 assign_row (to, from); |
4666 to->enabled_p = 1, from->enabled_p = 0; | |
25186
d6c941334567
(redraw_overlapping_rows): Use flag overlapping_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25118
diff
changeset
|
4667 to->overlapped_p = to_overlapped_p; |
25012 | 4668 } |
4669 } | |
4670 | |
29980
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4671 /* Clear the hash table, for the next time. */ |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4672 for (i = 0; i < row_entry_idx; ++i) |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4673 row_table[row_entry_pool[i].bucket] = NULL; |
171ba59e1cb0
(struct row_entry): New structure.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29687
diff
changeset
|
4674 |
54847
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
4675 /* Value is > 0 to indicate that we scrolled the display. */ |
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
4676 return nruns; |
25012 | 4677 } |
4678 | |
4679 | |
4680 | |
4681 /************************************************************************ | |
4682 Frame-Based Updates | |
4683 ************************************************************************/ | |
4684 | |
4685 /* Update the desired frame matrix of frame F. | |
4686 | |
4687 FORCE_P non-zero means that the update should not be stopped by | |
4688 pending input. INHIBIT_HAIRY_ID_P non-zero means that scrolling | |
4689 should not be tried. | |
4690 | |
4691 Value is non-zero if update was stopped due to pending input. */ | |
4692 | |
4693 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4694 update_frame_1 (struct frame *f, int force_p, int inhibit_id_p) |
25012 | 4695 { |
4696 /* Frame matrices to work on. */ | |
4697 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = f->current_matrix; | |
4698 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = f->desired_matrix; | |
4699 int i; | |
314 | 4700 int pause; |
4701 int preempt_count = baud_rate / 2400 + 1; | |
25012 | 4702 |
4703 xassert (current_matrix && desired_matrix); | |
314 | 4704 |
10122
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
4705 if (baud_rate != FRAME_COST_BAUD_RATE (f)) |
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
4706 calculate_costs (f); |
3de6776ae141
(update_frame): Call calculate_costs if baud_rate changed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
9963
diff
changeset
|
4707 |
3357
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
4708 if (preempt_count <= 0) |
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
4709 preempt_count = 1; |
d9523a958b3c
(update_frame): Make preempt_count positive.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3317
diff
changeset
|
4710 |
76065
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
4711 #if !PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
2001cae9df4e
(update_frame, update_single_window): Set force_p here if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
75371
diff
changeset
|
4712 if (!force_p && detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables ()) |
314 | 4713 { |
4714 pause = 1; | |
4715 goto do_pause; | |
4716 } | |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4717 #endif |
314 | 4718 |
25012 | 4719 /* If we cannot insert/delete lines, it's no use trying it. */ |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
4720 if (!FRAME_LINE_INS_DEL_OK (f)) |
25012 | 4721 inhibit_id_p = 1; |
7188
7da4ad9a2a8f
(update_frame): Move those assignments even farther down.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7179
diff
changeset
|
4722 |
493 | 4723 /* See if any of the desired lines are enabled; don't compute for |
25012 | 4724 i/d line if just want cursor motion. */ |
4725 for (i = 0; i < desired_matrix->nrows; i++) | |
4726 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) | |
314 | 4727 break; |
4728 | |
4729 /* Try doing i/d line, if not yet inhibited. */ | |
25012 | 4730 if (!inhibit_id_p && i < desired_matrix->nrows) |
4731 force_p |= scrolling (f); | |
314 | 4732 |
4733 /* Update the individual lines as needed. Do bottom line first. */ | |
25012 | 4734 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, desired_matrix->nrows - 1)) |
4735 update_frame_line (f, desired_matrix->nrows - 1); | |
4736 | |
4737 /* Now update the rest of the lines. */ | |
4738 for (i = 0; i < desired_matrix->nrows - 1 && (force_p || !input_pending); i++) | |
314 | 4739 { |
25012 | 4740 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) |
314 | 4741 { |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
4742 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f)) |
314 | 4743 { |
4744 /* Flush out every so many lines. | |
4745 Also flush out if likely to have more than 1k buffered | |
4746 otherwise. I'm told that some telnet connections get | |
4747 really screwed by more than 1k output at once. */ | |
94909
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4748 FILE *display_output = FRAME_TTY (f)->output; |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4749 if (display_output) |
314 | 4750 { |
94909
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4751 int outq = PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT (display_output); |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4752 if (outq > 900 |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4753 || (outq > 20 && ((i - 1) % preempt_count == 0))) |
314 | 4754 { |
94909
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4755 fflush (display_output); |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4756 if (preempt_count == 1) |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4757 { |
554 | 4758 #ifdef EMACS_OUTQSIZE |
94909
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4759 if (EMACS_OUTQSIZE (0, &outq) < 0) |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4760 /* Probably not a tty. Ignore the error and reset |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4761 the outq count. */ |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4762 outq = PENDING_OUTPUT_COUNT (FRAME_TTY (f->output)); |
314 | 4763 #endif |
94909
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4764 outq *= 10; |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4765 if (baud_rate <= outq && baud_rate > 0) |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4766 sleep (outq / baud_rate); |
11f28d8c2c22
(update_frame_1): Check if tty output is still valid before flushing
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
94513
diff
changeset
|
4767 } |
314 | 4768 } |
4769 } | |
4770 } | |
4771 | |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4772 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4773 if (!force_p) |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4774 { |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4775 EMACS_TIME tm, dif; |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4776 EMACS_GET_TIME (tm); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4777 EMACS_SUB_TIME (dif, preemption_next_check, tm); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4778 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (dif)) |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4779 { |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4780 EMACS_ADD_TIME (preemption_next_check, tm, preemption_period); |
71378
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
4781 if (detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables ()) |
1b442e9d8373
(update_frame): Check for input pending on entry.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71333
diff
changeset
|
4782 break; |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4783 } |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4784 } |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4785 #else |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4786 if (!force_p && (i - 1) % preempt_count == 0) |
59580
f43d0816e9c3
* keyboard.c (READABLE_EVENTS_DO_TIMERS_NOW)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58986
diff
changeset
|
4787 detect_input_pending_ignore_squeezables (); |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
4788 #endif |
16822
483e137d5384
(update_frame): Call detect_input_pending
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16589
diff
changeset
|
4789 |
25012 | 4790 update_frame_line (f, i); |
314 | 4791 } |
4792 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4793 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4794 pause = (i < FRAME_LINES (f) - 1) ? i : 0; |
314 | 4795 |
4796 /* Now just clean up termcap drivers and set cursor, etc. */ | |
4797 if (!pause) | |
4798 { | |
12409
6e374b28ecc3
(update_frame): Pretend cursor is in echo area
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12193
diff
changeset
|
4799 if ((cursor_in_echo_area |
25012 | 4800 /* If we are showing a message instead of the mini-buffer, |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
4801 show the cursor for the message instead of for the |
25012 | 4802 (now hidden) mini-buffer contents. */ |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
4803 || (EQ (minibuf_window, selected_window) |
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
4804 && EQ (minibuf_window, echo_area_window) |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
4805 && !NILP (echo_area_buffer[0]))) |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
4806 /* These cases apply only to the frame that contains |
25012 | 4807 the active mini-buffer window. */ |
12627
c7bc7a24b1ff
(update_frame): Check that the echo area is in the frame being displayed.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12532
diff
changeset
|
4808 && FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) |
14459
c1d25453a95f
(update_frame): Compare FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW(f)
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
14286
diff
changeset
|
4809 && EQ (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), echo_area_window)) |
708 | 4810 { |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4811 int top = WINDOW_TOP_EDGE_LINE (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f))); |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4812 int row, col; |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4813 |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4814 if (cursor_in_echo_area < 0) |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4815 { |
25012 | 4816 /* Negative value of cursor_in_echo_area means put |
4817 cursor at beginning of line. */ | |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4818 row = top; |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4819 col = 0; |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4820 } |
708 | 4821 else |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4822 { |
25012 | 4823 /* Positive value of cursor_in_echo_area means put |
4824 cursor at the end of the prompt. If the mini-buffer | |
4825 is several lines high, find the last line that has | |
4826 any text on it. */ | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4827 row = FRAME_LINES (f); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4828 do |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4829 { |
25012 | 4830 --row; |
4831 col = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4832 |
25012 | 4833 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (current_matrix, row)) |
4834 { | |
4835 /* Frame rows are filled up with spaces that | |
4836 must be ignored here. */ | |
4837 struct glyph_row *r = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, | |
4838 row); | |
4839 struct glyph *start = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
4840 struct glyph *last = start + r->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
4841 | |
4842 while (last > start | |
4843 && (last - 1)->charpos < 0) | |
4844 --last; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
4845 |
25012 | 4846 col = last - start; |
4847 } | |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4848 } |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4849 while (row > top && col == 0); |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4850 |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4851 /* Make sure COL is not out of range. */ |
21763
b685f9451792
(change_frame_size_1): Use FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21757
diff
changeset
|
4852 if (col >= FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT (f)) |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4853 { |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4854 /* If we have another row, advance cursor into it. */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4855 if (row < FRAME_LINES (f) - 1) |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4856 { |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4857 col = FRAME_LEFT_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f); |
21757
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4858 row++; |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4859 } |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4860 /* Otherwise move it back in range. */ |
629f6df4a329
(update_frame): Move echo area cursor into range.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21514
diff
changeset
|
4861 else |
21763
b685f9451792
(change_frame_size_1): Use FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21757
diff
changeset
|
4862 col = FRAME_CURSOR_X_LIMIT (f) - 1; |
1042
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4863 } |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4864 } |
41b77a76b885
* dispnew.c: Incude "systty.h", not "systerm.h".
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1003
diff
changeset
|
4865 |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
4866 cursor_to (f, row, col); |
708 | 4867 } |
314 | 4868 else |
25012 | 4869 { |
4870 /* We have only one cursor on terminal frames. Use it to | |
4871 display the cursor of the selected window. */ | |
4872 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f)); | |
29687
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
4873 if (w->cursor.vpos >= 0 |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
4874 /* The cursor vpos may be temporarily out of bounds |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
4875 in the following situation: There is one window, |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
4876 with the cursor in the lower half of it. The window |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
4877 is split, and a message causes a redisplay before |
5d67ef29764b
(update_frame_1): Handle case that cursor vpos is
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
29437
diff
changeset
|
4878 a new cursor position has been computed. */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4879 && w->cursor.vpos < WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (w)) |
25012 | 4880 { |
4881 int x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_HPOS (w, w->cursor.hpos); | |
4882 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_VPOS (w, w->cursor.vpos); | |
4883 | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4884 if (INTEGERP (w->left_margin_cols)) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4885 x += XFASTINT (w->left_margin_cols); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4886 |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4887 /* x = max (min (x, FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f) - 1), 0); */ |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
4888 cursor_to (f, y, x); |
25012 | 4889 } |
4890 } | |
314 | 4891 } |
4892 | |
111997
a5a188ddc758
Minor clean up to silence some gcc warnings.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
111640
diff
changeset
|
4893 #if !PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
314 | 4894 do_pause: |
111997
a5a188ddc758
Minor clean up to silence some gcc warnings.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
111640
diff
changeset
|
4895 #endif |
314 | 4896 |
25012 | 4897 clear_desired_matrices (f); |
314 | 4898 return pause; |
4899 } | |
4900 | |
25012 | 4901 |
4902 /* Do line insertions/deletions on frame F for frame-based redisplay. */ | |
314 | 4903 |
21514 | 4904 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4905 scrolling (struct frame *frame) |
314 | 4906 { |
4907 int unchanged_at_top, unchanged_at_bottom; | |
4908 int window_size; | |
4909 int changed_lines; | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4910 int *old_hash = (int *) alloca (FRAME_LINES (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4911 int *new_hash = (int *) alloca (FRAME_LINES (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4912 int *draw_cost = (int *) alloca (FRAME_LINES (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4913 int *old_draw_cost = (int *) alloca (FRAME_LINES (frame) * sizeof (int)); |
314 | 4914 register int i; |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4915 int free_at_end_vpos = FRAME_LINES (frame); |
25012 | 4916 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = frame->current_matrix; |
4917 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = frame->desired_matrix; | |
4918 | |
4919 if (!current_matrix) | |
4920 abort (); | |
4921 | |
4922 /* Compute hash codes of all the lines. Also calculate number of | |
4923 changed lines, number of unchanged lines at the beginning, and | |
4924 number of unchanged lines at the end. */ | |
314 | 4925 changed_lines = 0; |
4926 unchanged_at_top = 0; | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4927 unchanged_at_bottom = FRAME_LINES (frame); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4928 for (i = 0; i < FRAME_LINES (frame); i++) |
314 | 4929 { |
4930 /* Give up on this scrolling if some old lines are not enabled. */ | |
25012 | 4931 if (!MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (current_matrix, i)) |
314 | 4932 return 0; |
25012 | 4933 old_hash[i] = line_hash_code (MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, i)); |
4934 if (! MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (desired_matrix, i)) | |
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4935 { |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4936 /* This line cannot be redrawn, so don't let scrolling mess it. */ |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4937 new_hash[i] = old_hash[i]; |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4938 #define INFINITY 1000000 /* Taken from scroll.c */ |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4939 draw_cost[i] = INFINITY; |
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4940 } |
314 | 4941 else |
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4942 { |
25012 | 4943 new_hash[i] = line_hash_code (MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, i)); |
4944 draw_cost[i] = line_draw_cost (desired_matrix, i); | |
18015
934a44a3b34f
(scrolling): If a line is not enabled,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17961
diff
changeset
|
4945 } |
314 | 4946 |
4947 if (old_hash[i] != new_hash[i]) | |
4948 { | |
4949 changed_lines++; | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4950 unchanged_at_bottom = FRAME_LINES (frame) - i - 1; |
314 | 4951 } |
4952 else if (i == unchanged_at_top) | |
4953 unchanged_at_top++; | |
25012 | 4954 old_draw_cost[i] = line_draw_cost (current_matrix, i); |
314 | 4955 } |
4956 | |
4957 /* If changed lines are few, don't allow preemption, don't scroll. */ | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
4958 if ((!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (frame) |
53225
4250e7e26247
Add a level of indirection to terminal characteristics.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
4959 && changed_lines < baud_rate / 2400) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4960 || unchanged_at_bottom == FRAME_LINES (frame)) |
314 | 4961 return 1; |
4962 | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4963 window_size = (FRAME_LINES (frame) - unchanged_at_top |
314 | 4964 - unchanged_at_bottom); |
4965 | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
4966 if (FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (frame)) |
314 | 4967 free_at_end_vpos -= unchanged_at_bottom; |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
4968 else if (FRAME_MEMORY_BELOW_FRAME (frame)) |
314 | 4969 free_at_end_vpos = -1; |
4970 | |
4971 /* If large window, fast terminal and few lines in common between | |
25012 | 4972 current frame and desired frame, don't bother with i/d calc. */ |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
4973 if (!FRAME_SCROLL_REGION_OK (frame) |
53225
4250e7e26247
Add a level of indirection to terminal characteristics.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
4974 && window_size >= 18 && baud_rate > 2400 |
314 | 4975 && (window_size >= |
4976 10 * scrolling_max_lines_saved (unchanged_at_top, | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
4977 FRAME_LINES (frame) - unchanged_at_bottom, |
314 | 4978 old_hash, new_hash, draw_cost))) |
4979 return 0; | |
4980 | |
25012 | 4981 if (window_size < 2) |
4982 return 0; | |
4983 | |
764 | 4984 scrolling_1 (frame, window_size, unchanged_at_top, unchanged_at_bottom, |
314 | 4985 draw_cost + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
10259
48e4dfc6bb43
(scrolling): Fewer restrictions if scroll_region_ok is
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10122
diff
changeset
|
4986 old_draw_cost + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
314 | 4987 old_hash + unchanged_at_top - 1, |
4988 new_hash + unchanged_at_top - 1, | |
4989 free_at_end_vpos - unchanged_at_top); | |
4990 | |
4991 return 0; | |
4992 } | |
25012 | 4993 |
4994 | |
4995 /* Count the number of blanks at the start of the vector of glyphs R | |
4996 which is LEN glyphs long. */ | |
4997 | |
4998 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4999 count_blanks (struct glyph *r, int len) |
314 | 5000 { |
25012 | 5001 int i; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5002 |
25012 | 5003 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i) |
5004 if (!CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (r[i])) | |
5005 break; | |
5006 | |
5007 return i; | |
314 | 5008 } |
25012 | 5009 |
5010 | |
5011 /* Count the number of glyphs in common at the start of the glyph | |
5012 vectors STR1 and STR2. END1 is the end of STR1 and END2 is the end | |
5013 of STR2. Value is the number of equal glyphs equal at the start. */ | |
314 | 5014 |
5015 static int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5016 count_match (struct glyph *str1, struct glyph *end1, struct glyph *str2, struct glyph *end2) |
314 | 5017 { |
25012 | 5018 struct glyph *p1 = str1; |
5019 struct glyph *p2 = str2; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5020 |
25012 | 5021 while (p1 < end1 |
5022 && p2 < end2 | |
26998
02e902f732d1
(line_hash_code) (direct_output_for_insert): Adjusted
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
26902
diff
changeset
|
5023 && GLYPH_CHAR_AND_FACE_EQUAL_P (p1, p2)) |
25012 | 5024 ++p1, ++p2; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5025 |
25012 | 5026 return p1 - str1; |
314 | 5027 } |
5028 | |
25012 | 5029 |
314 | 5030 /* Char insertion/deletion cost vector, from term.c */ |
25012 | 5031 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5032 #define char_ins_del_cost(f) (&char_ins_del_vector[FRAME_TOTAL_COLS((f))]) |
314 | 5033 |
25012 | 5034 |
5035 /* Perform a frame-based update on line VPOS in frame FRAME. */ | |
5036 | |
314 | 5037 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5038 update_frame_line (struct frame *f, int vpos) |
314 | 5039 { |
25012 | 5040 struct glyph *obody, *nbody, *op1, *op2, *np1, *nend; |
314 | 5041 int tem; |
5042 int osp, nsp, begmatch, endmatch, olen, nlen; | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5043 struct glyph_matrix *current_matrix = f->current_matrix; |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5044 struct glyph_matrix *desired_matrix = f->desired_matrix; |
25012 | 5045 struct glyph_row *current_row = MATRIX_ROW (current_matrix, vpos); |
5046 struct glyph_row *desired_row = MATRIX_ROW (desired_matrix, vpos); | |
5047 int must_write_whole_line_p; | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
5048 int write_spaces_p = FRAME_MUST_WRITE_SPACES (f); |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5049 int colored_spaces_p = (FACE_FROM_ID (f, DEFAULT_FACE_ID)->background |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5050 != FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_BG_COLOR); |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5051 |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5052 if (colored_spaces_p) |
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5053 write_spaces_p = 1; |
25012 | 5054 |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5055 /* Current row not enabled means it has unknown contents. We must |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5056 write the whole desired line in that case. */ |
25012 | 5057 must_write_whole_line_p = !current_row->enabled_p; |
5058 if (must_write_whole_line_p) | |
314 | 5059 { |
25012 | 5060 obody = 0; |
314 | 5061 olen = 0; |
5062 } | |
5063 else | |
5064 { | |
25012 | 5065 obody = MATRIX_ROW_GLYPH_START (current_matrix, vpos); |
5066 olen = current_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5067 |
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5068 /* Ignore trailing spaces, if we can. */ |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5069 if (!write_spaces_p) |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5070 while (olen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (obody[olen-1])) |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5071 olen--; |
314 | 5072 } |
5073 | |
25012 | 5074 current_row->enabled_p = 1; |
5075 current_row->used[TEXT_AREA] = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5076 | |
5077 /* If desired line is empty, just clear the line. */ | |
5078 if (!desired_row->enabled_p) | |
314 | 5079 { |
5080 nlen = 0; | |
5081 goto just_erase; | |
5082 } | |
5083 | |
25012 | 5084 nbody = desired_row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
5085 nlen = desired_row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5086 nend = nbody + nlen; | |
5087 | |
5088 /* If display line has unknown contents, write the whole line. */ | |
5089 if (must_write_whole_line_p) | |
5090 { | |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5091 /* Ignore spaces at the end, if we can. */ |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5092 if (!write_spaces_p) |
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5093 while (nlen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (nbody[nlen - 1])) |
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5094 --nlen; |
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5095 |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5096 /* Write the contents of the desired line. */ |
25313
6b4475fbef86
(update_frame_line): If writing whole line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25304
diff
changeset
|
5097 if (nlen) |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5098 { |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5099 cursor_to (f, vpos, 0); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5100 write_glyphs (f, nbody, nlen); |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5101 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5102 |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5103 /* Don't call clear_end_of_line if we already wrote the whole |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5104 line. The cursor will not be at the right margin in that |
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5105 case but in the line below. */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5106 if (nlen < FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)) |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5107 { |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5108 cursor_to (f, vpos, nlen); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5109 clear_end_of_line (f, FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)); |
25725
b7468dc89ccb
(update_frame_line): If writing whole desired line,
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25666
diff
changeset
|
5110 } |
28682
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5111 else |
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5112 /* Make sure we are in the right row, otherwise cursor movement |
f05d48759416
(update_frame_line): When writing a whole line, make
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
28507
diff
changeset
|
5113 with cmgoto might use `ch' in the wrong row. */ |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5114 cursor_to (f, vpos, 0); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5115 |
25012 | 5116 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
5117 return; | |
5118 } | |
314 | 5119 |
5120 /* Pretend trailing spaces are not there at all, | |
5121 unless for one reason or another we must write all spaces. */ | |
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5122 if (!write_spaces_p) |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5123 while (nlen > 0 && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (nbody[nlen - 1])) |
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5124 nlen--; |
314 | 5125 |
5126 /* If there's no i/d char, quickly do the best we can without it. */ | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
5127 if (!FRAME_CHAR_INS_DEL_OK (f)) |
314 | 5128 { |
25012 | 5129 int i, j; |
5130 | |
5131 /* Find the first glyph in desired row that doesn't agree with | |
5132 a glyph in the current row, and write the rest from there on. */ | |
314 | 5133 for (i = 0; i < nlen; i++) |
5134 { | |
25012 | 5135 if (i >= olen || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (nbody + i, obody + i)) |
314 | 5136 { |
25012 | 5137 /* Find the end of the run of different glyphs. */ |
5138 j = i + 1; | |
5139 while (j < nlen | |
5140 && (j >= olen | |
5141 || !GLYPH_EQUAL_P (nbody + j, obody + j) | |
5142 || CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (nbody[j]))) | |
5143 ++j; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5144 |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5145 /* Output this run of non-matching chars. */ |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5146 cursor_to (f, vpos, i); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5147 write_glyphs (f, nbody + i, j - i); |
25012 | 5148 i = j - 1; |
314 | 5149 |
5150 /* Now find the next non-match. */ | |
5151 } | |
5152 } | |
5153 | |
5154 /* Clear the rest of the line, or the non-clear part of it. */ | |
5155 if (olen > nlen) | |
5156 { | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5157 cursor_to (f, vpos, nlen); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5158 clear_end_of_line (f, olen); |
314 | 5159 } |
5160 | |
25012 | 5161 /* Make current row = desired row. */ |
5162 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); | |
314 | 5163 return; |
5164 } | |
5165 | |
25012 | 5166 /* Here when CHAR_INS_DEL_OK != 0, i.e. we can insert or delete |
5167 characters in a row. */ | |
5168 | |
314 | 5169 if (!olen) |
5170 { | |
25012 | 5171 /* If current line is blank, skip over initial spaces, if |
5172 possible, and write the rest. */ | |
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5173 if (write_spaces_p) |
25012 | 5174 nsp = 0; |
5175 else | |
5176 nsp = count_blanks (nbody, nlen); | |
5177 | |
314 | 5178 if (nlen > nsp) |
5179 { | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5180 cursor_to (f, vpos, nsp); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5181 write_glyphs (f, nbody + nsp, nlen - nsp); |
314 | 5182 } |
5183 | |
764 | 5184 /* Exchange contents between current_frame and new_frame. */ |
25012 | 5185 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
314 | 5186 return; |
5187 } | |
5188 | |
5189 /* Compute number of leading blanks in old and new contents. */ | |
25012 | 5190 osp = count_blanks (obody, olen); |
40075
c1d88076fa85
(update_frame_line): Don't call reassert_line_highlight.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39988
diff
changeset
|
5191 nsp = (colored_spaces_p ? 0 : count_blanks (nbody, nlen)); |
25012 | 5192 |
5193 /* Compute number of matching chars starting with first non-blank. */ | |
5194 begmatch = count_match (obody + osp, obody + olen, | |
5195 nbody + nsp, nbody + nlen); | |
314 | 5196 |
5197 /* Spaces in new match implicit space past the end of old. */ | |
5198 /* A bug causing this to be a no-op was fixed in 18.29. */ | |
33101
39cd5f99c67d
(update_frame_line): Handle case where spaces in
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
32752
diff
changeset
|
5199 if (!write_spaces_p && osp + begmatch == olen) |
314 | 5200 { |
5201 np1 = nbody + nsp; | |
25012 | 5202 while (np1 + begmatch < nend && CHAR_GLYPH_SPACE_P (np1[begmatch])) |
5203 ++begmatch; | |
314 | 5204 } |
5205 | |
5206 /* Avoid doing insert/delete char | |
5207 just cause number of leading spaces differs | |
25012 | 5208 when the following text does not match. */ |
314 | 5209 if (begmatch == 0 && osp != nsp) |
5210 osp = nsp = min (osp, nsp); | |
5211 | |
5212 /* Find matching characters at end of line */ | |
5213 op1 = obody + olen; | |
5214 np1 = nbody + nlen; | |
5215 op2 = op1 + begmatch - min (olen - osp, nlen - nsp); | |
25012 | 5216 while (op1 > op2 |
5217 && GLYPH_EQUAL_P (op1 - 1, np1 - 1)) | |
314 | 5218 { |
5219 op1--; | |
5220 np1--; | |
5221 } | |
5222 endmatch = obody + olen - op1; | |
5223 | |
5224 /* tem gets the distance to insert or delete. | |
5225 endmatch is how many characters we save by doing so. | |
5226 Is it worth it? */ | |
5227 | |
5228 tem = (nlen - nsp) - (olen - osp); | |
5229 if (endmatch && tem | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
5230 && (!FRAME_CHAR_INS_DEL_OK (f) |
53225
4250e7e26247
Add a level of indirection to terminal characteristics.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5231 || endmatch <= char_ins_del_cost (f)[tem])) |
314 | 5232 endmatch = 0; |
5233 | |
5234 /* nsp - osp is the distance to insert or delete. | |
5235 If that is nonzero, begmatch is known to be nonzero also. | |
5236 begmatch + endmatch is how much we save by doing the ins/del. | |
5237 Is it worth it? */ | |
5238 | |
5239 if (nsp != osp | |
82990
2ecd1f669db9
Fixed X support, preliminary support for X-tty combo sessions.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82989
diff
changeset
|
5240 && (!FRAME_CHAR_INS_DEL_OK (f) |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5241 || begmatch + endmatch <= char_ins_del_cost (f)[nsp - osp])) |
314 | 5242 { |
5243 begmatch = 0; | |
5244 endmatch = 0; | |
5245 osp = nsp = min (osp, nsp); | |
5246 } | |
5247 | |
5248 /* Now go through the line, inserting, writing and | |
5249 deleting as appropriate. */ | |
5250 | |
5251 if (osp > nsp) | |
5252 { | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5253 cursor_to (f, vpos, nsp); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5254 delete_glyphs (f, osp - nsp); |
314 | 5255 } |
5256 else if (nsp > osp) | |
5257 { | |
5258 /* If going to delete chars later in line | |
5259 and insert earlier in the line, | |
5260 must delete first to avoid losing data in the insert */ | |
5261 if (endmatch && nlen < olen + nsp - osp) | |
5262 { | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5263 cursor_to (f, vpos, nlen - endmatch + osp - nsp); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5264 delete_glyphs (f, olen + nsp - osp - nlen); |
314 | 5265 olen = nlen - (nsp - osp); |
5266 } | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5267 cursor_to (f, vpos, osp); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5268 insert_glyphs (f, 0, nsp - osp); |
314 | 5269 } |
5270 olen += nsp - osp; | |
5271 | |
5272 tem = nsp + begmatch + endmatch; | |
5273 if (nlen != tem || olen != tem) | |
5274 { | |
5275 if (!endmatch || nlen == olen) | |
5276 { | |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5277 /* If new text being written reaches right margin, there is |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5278 no need to do clear-to-eol at the end of this function |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5279 (and it would not be safe, since cursor is not going to |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5280 be "at the margin" after the text is done). */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5281 if (nlen == FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)) |
314 | 5282 olen = 0; |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5283 |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5284 /* Function write_glyphs is prepared to do nothing |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5285 if passed a length <= 0. Check it here to avoid |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5286 unnecessary cursor movement. */ |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5287 if (nlen - tem > 0) |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5288 { |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5289 cursor_to (f, vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5290 write_glyphs (f, nbody + nsp + begmatch, nlen - tem); |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5291 } |
314 | 5292 } |
5293 else if (nlen > olen) | |
5294 { | |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5295 /* Here, we used to have the following simple code: |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5296 ---------------------------------------- |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5297 write_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch, olen - tem); |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5298 insert_glyphs (nbody + nsp + begmatch + olen - tem, nlen - olen); |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5299 ---------------------------------------- |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5300 but it doesn't work if nbody[nsp + begmatch + olen - tem] |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5301 is a padding glyph. */ |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5302 int out = olen - tem; /* Columns to be overwritten originally. */ |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5303 int del; |
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5304 |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5305 cursor_to (f, vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5306 |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5307 /* Calculate columns we can actually overwrite. */ |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5308 while (CHAR_GLYPH_PADDING_P (nbody[nsp + begmatch + out])) |
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5309 out--; |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5310 write_glyphs (f, nbody + nsp + begmatch, out); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5311 |
25012 | 5312 /* If we left columns to be overwritten, we must delete them. */ |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5313 del = olen - tem - out; |
35924
32198b7c21e1
(update_frame_line): Rename parameter FRAME to F.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
35609
diff
changeset
|
5314 if (del > 0) |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5315 delete_glyphs (f, del); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5316 |
17015
fe0b3661b584
(direct_output_forward_char): #if-0-out redundant
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
16896
diff
changeset
|
5317 /* At last, we insert columns not yet written out. */ |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5318 insert_glyphs (f, nbody + nsp + begmatch + out, nlen - olen + del); |
314 | 5319 olen = nlen; |
5320 } | |
5321 else if (olen > nlen) | |
5322 { | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5323 cursor_to (f, vpos, nsp + begmatch); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5324 write_glyphs (f, nbody + nsp + begmatch, nlen - tem); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5325 delete_glyphs (f, olen - nlen); |
314 | 5326 olen = nlen; |
5327 } | |
5328 } | |
5329 | |
5330 just_erase: | |
5331 /* If any unerased characters remain after the new line, erase them. */ | |
5332 if (olen > nlen) | |
5333 { | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5334 cursor_to (f, vpos, nlen); |
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5335 clear_end_of_line (f, olen); |
314 | 5336 } |
5337 | |
764 | 5338 /* Exchange contents between current_frame and new_frame. */ |
25012 | 5339 make_current (desired_matrix, current_matrix, vpos); |
314 | 5340 } |
25012 | 5341 |
5342 | |
314 | 5343 |
25012 | 5344 /*********************************************************************** |
5345 X/Y Position -> Buffer Position | |
5346 ***********************************************************************/ | |
5347 | |
36697
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5348 /* Determine what's under window-relative pixel position (*X, *Y). |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5349 Return the OBJECT (string or buffer) that's there. |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5350 Return in *POS the position in that object. |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5351 Adjust *X and *Y to character positions. |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5352 Return in *DX and *DY the pixel coordinates of the click, |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5353 relative to the top left corner of OBJECT, or relative to |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5354 the top left corner of the character glyph at (*X, *Y) |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5355 if OBJECT is nil. |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5356 Return WIDTH and HEIGHT of the object at (*X, *Y), or zero |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5357 if the coordinates point to an empty area of the display. */ |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5358 |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5359 Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5360 buffer_posn_from_coords (struct window *w, int *x, int *y, struct display_pos *pos, Lisp_Object *object, int *dx, int *dy, int *width, int *height) |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5361 { |
25012 | 5362 struct it it; |
101464
f34b82b3a6e0
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Use Fset_buffer instead of setting
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
5363 Lisp_Object old_current_buffer = Fcurrent_buffer (); |
25012 | 5364 struct text_pos startp; |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5365 Lisp_Object string; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5366 struct glyph_row *row; |
55021
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5367 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5368 struct image *img = 0; |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5369 #endif |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5370 int x0, x1, to_x; |
25012 | 5371 |
101464
f34b82b3a6e0
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Use Fset_buffer instead of setting
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
5372 /* We used to set current_buffer directly here, but that does the |
f34b82b3a6e0
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Use Fset_buffer instead of setting
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
5373 wrong thing with `face-remapping-alist' (bug#2044). */ |
f34b82b3a6e0
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Use Fset_buffer instead of setting
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
5374 Fset_buffer (w->buffer); |
25012 | 5375 SET_TEXT_POS_FROM_MARKER (startp, w->start); |
5376 CHARPOS (startp) = min (ZV, max (BEGV, CHARPOS (startp))); | |
5377 BYTEPOS (startp) = min (ZV_BYTE, max (BEGV_BYTE, BYTEPOS (startp))); | |
5378 start_display (&it, w, startp); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5379 |
111566
b4dbe6c4111e
Cleanup of window coordinate positioning code.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111564
diff
changeset
|
5380 x0 = *x; |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5381 |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5382 /* First, move to the beginning of the row corresponding to *Y. We |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5383 need to be in that row to get the correct value of base paragraph |
109905
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5384 direction for the text at (*X, *Y). */ |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5385 move_it_to (&it, -1, 0, *y, -1, MOVE_TO_X | MOVE_TO_Y); |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5386 |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5387 /* TO_X is the pixel position that the iterator will compute for the |
109905
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5388 glyph at *X. We add it.first_visible_x because iterator |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5389 positions include the hscroll. */ |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5390 to_x = x0 + it.first_visible_x; |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5391 if (it.bidi_it.paragraph_dir == R2L) |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5392 /* For lines in an R2L paragraph, we need to mirror TO_X wrt the |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5393 text area. This is because the iterator, even in R2L |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5394 paragraphs, delivers glyphs as if they started at the left |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5395 margin of the window. (When we actually produce glyphs for |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5396 display, we reverse their order in PRODUCE_GLYPHS, but the |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5397 iterator doesn't know about that.) The following line adjusts |
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5398 the pixel position to the iterator geometry, which is what |
109905
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5399 move_it_* routines use. (The -1 is because in a window whose |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5400 text-area width is W, the rightmost pixel position is W-1, and |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5401 it should be mirrored into zero pixel position.) */ |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5402 to_x = window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA) - to_x - 1; |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5403 |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5404 /* Now move horizontally in the row to the glyph under *X. Second |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5405 argument is ZV to prevent move_it_in_display_line from matching |
c2d849aa4021
Fix mirroring pixel positions on GUI terminals.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109896
diff
changeset
|
5406 based on buffer positions. */ |
109886
43a4dcd16d73
Fix mouse clicks, drag, and highlight in R2L lines.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
109660
diff
changeset
|
5407 move_it_in_display_line (&it, ZV, to_x, MOVE_TO_X); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5408 |
101464
f34b82b3a6e0
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Use Fset_buffer instead of setting
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
5409 Fset_buffer (old_current_buffer); |
36697
7526acd3385c
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Add parameters OBJECT and
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
36590
diff
changeset
|
5410 |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5411 *dx = x0 + it.first_visible_x - it.current_x; |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5412 *dy = *y - it.current_y; |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5413 |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5414 string = w->buffer; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5415 if (STRINGP (it.string)) |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5416 string = it.string; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5417 *pos = it.current; |
110469
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5418 if (it.what == IT_COMPOSITION |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5419 && it.cmp_it.nchars > 1 |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5420 && it.cmp_it.reversed_p) |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5421 { |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5422 /* The current display element is a grapheme cluster in a |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5423 composition. In that case, we need the position of the first |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5424 character of the cluster. But, as it.cmp_it.reversed_p is 1, |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5425 it.current points to the last character of the cluster, thus |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5426 we must move back to the first character of the same |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5427 cluster. */ |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5428 CHARPOS (pos->pos) -= it.cmp_it.nchars - 1; |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5429 if (STRINGP (it.string)) |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5430 BYTEPOS (pos->pos) = string_char_to_byte (string, CHARPOS (pos->pos)); |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5431 else |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5432 BYTEPOS (pos->pos) = CHAR_TO_BYTE (CHARPOS (pos->pos)); |
9fa0b071facc
Fix position calculation on mouse click within bidi-reordered composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
109905
diff
changeset
|
5433 } |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5434 |
53190
053a4dfb6bd4
* dispnew.c (buffer_posn_from_coords): Add ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53176
diff
changeset
|
5435 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5436 if (it.what == IT_IMAGE) |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5437 { |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5438 if ((img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (it.f, it.image_id)) != NULL |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5439 && !NILP (img->spec)) |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5440 *object = img->spec; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5441 } |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5442 #endif |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5443 |
65016
2b179104bc17
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Check that target row is
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65003
diff
changeset
|
5444 if (it.vpos < w->current_matrix->nrows |
2b179104bc17
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Check that target row is
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65003
diff
changeset
|
5445 && (row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, it.vpos), |
2b179104bc17
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Check that target row is
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
65003
diff
changeset
|
5446 row->enabled_p)) |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5447 { |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5448 if (it.hpos < row->used[TEXT_AREA]) |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5449 { |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5450 struct glyph *glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA] + it.hpos; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5451 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
55021
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5452 if (img) |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5453 { |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5454 *dy -= row->ascent - glyph->ascent; |
110598
ee58b36ab139
Remove restriction on the number of glyphs in one composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5455 *dx += glyph->slice.img.x; |
ee58b36ab139
Remove restriction on the number of glyphs in one composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5456 *dy += glyph->slice.img.y; |
55021
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5457 /* Image slices positions are still relative to the entire image */ |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5458 *width = img->width; |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5459 *height = img->height; |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5460 } |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5461 else |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5462 #endif |
55021
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5463 { |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5464 *width = glyph->pixel_width; |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5465 *height = glyph->ascent + glyph->descent; |
78fbab658433
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return full image width
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54847
diff
changeset
|
5466 } |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5467 } |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5468 else |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5469 { |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5470 *width = 0; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5471 *height = row->height; |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5472 } |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5473 } |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5474 else |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5475 { |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5476 *width = *height = 0; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5477 } |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5478 |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5479 /* Add extra (default width) columns if clicked after EOL. */ |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5480 x1 = max(0, it.current_x + it.pixel_width - it.first_visible_x); |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5481 if (x0 > x1) |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5482 it.hpos += (x0 - x1) / WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w); |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5483 |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5484 *x = it.hpos; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5485 *y = it.vpos; |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5486 |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5487 return string; |
25012 | 5488 } |
5489 | |
5490 | |
5491 /* Value is the string under window-relative coordinates X/Y in the | |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5492 mode line or header line (PART says which) of window W, or nil if none. |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5493 *CHARPOS is set to the position in the string returned. */ |
25012 | 5494 |
5495 Lisp_Object | |
110552
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5496 mode_line_string (struct window *w, enum window_part part, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5497 int *x, int *y, EMACS_INT *charpos, Lisp_Object *object, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5498 int *dx, int *dy, int *width, int *height) |
25012 | 5499 { |
5500 struct glyph_row *row; | |
5501 struct glyph *glyph, *end; | |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5502 int x0, y0; |
25012 | 5503 Lisp_Object string = Qnil; |
5504 | |
50218
06f75553f0a4
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Use enum
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
5505 if (part == ON_MODE_LINE) |
25012 | 5506 row = MATRIX_MODE_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix); |
5507 else | |
25546 | 5508 row = MATRIX_HEADER_LINE_ROW (w->current_matrix); |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5509 y0 = *y - row->y; |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5510 *y = row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix); |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5511 |
25012 | 5512 if (row->mode_line_p && row->enabled_p) |
11919
31cb053405f2
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Record frame names
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
5513 { |
25012 | 5514 /* Find the glyph under X. If we find one with a string object, |
5515 it's the one we were looking for. */ | |
5516 glyph = row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; | |
5517 end = glyph + row->used[TEXT_AREA]; | |
59592
c0533d2d03af
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Fix
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59580
diff
changeset
|
5518 for (x0 = *x; glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width; ++glyph) |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5519 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5520 *x = glyph - row->glyphs[TEXT_AREA]; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5521 if (glyph < end) |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5522 { |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5523 string = glyph->object; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5524 *charpos = glyph->charpos; |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5525 *width = glyph->pixel_width; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5526 *height = glyph->ascent + glyph->descent; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5527 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5528 if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH) |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5529 { |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5530 struct image *img; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5531 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (WINDOW_XFRAME (w), glyph->u.img_id); |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5532 if (img != NULL) |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5533 *object = img->spec; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5534 y0 -= row->ascent - glyph->ascent; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5535 } |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5536 #endif |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5537 } |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5538 else |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5539 { |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5540 /* Add extra (default width) columns if clicked after EOL. */ |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5541 *x += x0 / WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w); |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5542 *width = 0; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5543 *height = row->height; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5544 } |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5545 } |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5546 else |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5547 { |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5548 *x = 0; |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5549 x0 = 0; |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5550 *width = *height = 0; |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5551 } |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5552 |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5553 *dx = x0; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5554 *dy = y0; |
25012 | 5555 |
5556 return string; | |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
5557 } |
25012 | 5558 |
5559 | |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5560 /* Value is the string under window-relative coordinates X/Y in either |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5561 marginal area, or nil if none. *CHARPOS is set to the position in |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5562 the string returned. */ |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5563 |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5564 Lisp_Object |
110552
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5565 marginal_area_string (struct window *w, enum window_part part, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5566 int *x, int *y, EMACS_INT *charpos, Lisp_Object *object, |
66f6be9b4d43
Fix int/EMACS_INT use in ccl.c, cmds.c, data.c, dispnew.c.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5567 int *dx, int *dy, int *width, int *height) |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5568 { |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5569 struct glyph_row *row = w->current_matrix->rows; |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5570 struct glyph *glyph, *end; |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5571 int x0, y0, i, wy = *y; |
50218
06f75553f0a4
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Use enum
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
5572 int area; |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5573 Lisp_Object string = Qnil; |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5574 |
50218
06f75553f0a4
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Use enum
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
5575 if (part == ON_LEFT_MARGIN) |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5576 area = LEFT_MARGIN_AREA; |
50218
06f75553f0a4
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Use enum
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
5577 else if (part == ON_RIGHT_MARGIN) |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5578 area = RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA; |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5579 else |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5580 abort (); |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5581 |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5582 for (i = 0; row->enabled_p && i < w->current_matrix->nrows; ++i, ++row) |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5583 if (wy >= row->y && wy < MATRIX_ROW_BOTTOM_Y (row)) |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5584 break; |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5585 y0 = *y - row->y; |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5586 *y = row - MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix); |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5587 |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5588 if (row->enabled_p) |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5589 { |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5590 /* Find the glyph under X. If we find one with a string object, |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5591 it's the one we were looking for. */ |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5592 if (area == RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5593 x0 = ((WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w) |
54847
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
5594 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5595 : WINDOW_TOTAL_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5596 + window_box_width (w, LEFT_MARGIN_AREA) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5597 + window_box_width (w, TEXT_AREA)); |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5598 else |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5599 x0 = (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w) |
54847
5acc1d864551
(update_window): Only set changed_p if
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
54176
diff
changeset
|
5600 ? WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5601 : 0); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5602 |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5603 glyph = row->glyphs[area]; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5604 end = glyph + row->used[area]; |
59592
c0533d2d03af
(mode_line_string, marginal_area_string): Fix
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59580
diff
changeset
|
5605 for (x0 = *x - x0; glyph < end && x0 >= glyph->pixel_width; ++glyph) |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5606 x0 -= glyph->pixel_width; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5607 *x = glyph - row->glyphs[area]; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5608 if (glyph < end) |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5609 { |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5610 string = glyph->object; |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5611 *charpos = glyph->charpos; |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5612 *width = glyph->pixel_width; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5613 *height = glyph->ascent + glyph->descent; |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5614 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5615 if (glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH) |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5616 { |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5617 struct image *img; |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5618 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (WINDOW_XFRAME (w), glyph->u.img_id); |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5619 if (img != NULL) |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5620 *object = img->spec; |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5621 y0 -= row->ascent - glyph->ascent; |
110598
ee58b36ab139
Remove restriction on the number of glyphs in one composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5622 x0 += glyph->slice.img.x; |
ee58b36ab139
Remove restriction on the number of glyphs in one composition.
Kenichi Handa <handa@m17n.org>
parents:
110469
diff
changeset
|
5623 y0 += glyph->slice.img.y; |
53329
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5624 } |
9c540a878edf
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Fix calculation of dy for
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53190
diff
changeset
|
5625 #endif |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5626 } |
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5627 else |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5628 { |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5629 /* Add extra (default width) columns if clicked after EOL. */ |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5630 *x += x0 / WINDOW_FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (w); |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5631 *width = 0; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5632 *height = row->height; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5633 } |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5634 } |
53127
bc14fd4782c3
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return actual row/column
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53055
diff
changeset
|
5635 else |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5636 { |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5637 x0 = 0; |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5638 *x = 0; |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5639 *width = *height = 0; |
53176
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5640 } |
b246aabe1c49
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Calculate and return pixel
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53127
diff
changeset
|
5641 |
53514
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5642 *dx = x0; |
db81ac8829b6
(buffer_posn_from_coords): Return both buffer/string
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
53329
diff
changeset
|
5643 *dy = y0; |
44536
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5644 |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5645 return string; |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5646 } |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5647 |
f7b9d913406b
(marginal_area_string): New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
44261
diff
changeset
|
5648 |
25012 | 5649 /*********************************************************************** |
5650 Changing Frame Sizes | |
5651 ***********************************************************************/ | |
314 | 5652 |
5653 #ifdef SIGWINCH | |
25012 | 5654 |
493 | 5655 SIGTYPE |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5656 window_change_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */ |
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5657 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */ |
314 | 5658 { |
5659 int width, height; | |
5660 int old_errno = errno; | |
5661 | |
82989
f3845715a5f6
Separate frame-local, tty-dependent parameters from tty-local parameters.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82987
diff
changeset
|
5662 struct tty_display_info *tty; |
82995
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5663 |
58986
59945307b86b
* syssignal.h: Declare main_thread.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57808
diff
changeset
|
5664 signal (SIGWINCH, window_change_signal); |
59945307b86b
* syssignal.h: Declare main_thread.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57808
diff
changeset
|
5665 SIGNAL_THREAD_CHECK (signalnum); |
59945307b86b
* syssignal.h: Declare main_thread.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57808
diff
changeset
|
5666 |
53229
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5667 /* The frame size change obviously applies to a single |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5668 termcap-controlled terminal, but we can't decide which. |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5669 Therefore, we resize the frames corresponding to each tty. |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5670 */ |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5671 for (tty = tty_list; tty; tty = tty->next) { |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5672 |
53341 | 5673 if (! tty->term_initted) |
5674 continue; | |
82995
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5675 |
101690
1009d5607716
* dispnew.c (window_change_signal): Don't try to get the size of a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
101464
diff
changeset
|
5676 /* Suspended tty frames have tty->input == NULL avoid trying to |
1009d5607716
* dispnew.c (window_change_signal): Don't try to get the size of a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
101464
diff
changeset
|
5677 use it. */ |
1009d5607716
* dispnew.c (window_change_signal): Don't try to get the size of a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
101464
diff
changeset
|
5678 if (!tty->input) |
1009d5607716
* dispnew.c (window_change_signal): Don't try to get the size of a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
101464
diff
changeset
|
5679 continue; |
1009d5607716
* dispnew.c (window_change_signal): Don't try to get the size of a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
101464
diff
changeset
|
5680 |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5681 get_tty_size (fileno (tty->input), &width, &height); |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
5682 |
83412
573105015a96
Work around Emacs crash on Konsole detach. (Tom Schutzer-Weissmann)
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83384
diff
changeset
|
5683 if (width > 5 && height > 2) { |
53229
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5684 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
5685 |
53229
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5686 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
82995
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5687 if (FRAME_TERMCAP_P (XFRAME (frame)) && FRAME_TTY (XFRAME (frame)) == tty) |
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5688 /* Record the new sizes, but don't reallocate the data |
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5689 structures now. Let that be done later outside of the |
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5690 signal handler. */ |
039bd6989d29
Portability fixes (now it compiles & runs fine on Solaris).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
82992
diff
changeset
|
5691 change_frame_size (XFRAME (frame), height, width, 0, 1, 0); |
53229
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5692 } |
314 | 5693 } |
5694 | |
5695 errno = old_errno; | |
5696 } | |
5697 #endif /* SIGWINCH */ | |
5698 | |
5699 | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5700 /* Do any change in frame size that was requested by a signal. SAFE |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5701 non-zero means this function is called from a place where it is |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5702 safe to change frame sizes while a redisplay is in progress. */ |
314 | 5703 |
21514 | 5704 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5705 do_pending_window_change (int safe) |
314 | 5706 { |
5707 /* If window_change_signal should have run before, run it now. */ | |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5708 if (redisplaying_p && !safe) |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5709 return; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5710 |
314 | 5711 while (delayed_size_change) |
5712 { | |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5713 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
314 | 5714 |
5715 delayed_size_change = 0; | |
5716 | |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5717 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
314 | 5718 { |
25012 | 5719 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame); |
2252
9793d8654e23
* frame.h (FOR_EACH_FRAME): Change the definition so that
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2198
diff
changeset
|
5720 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5721 if (f->new_text_lines != 0 || f->new_text_cols != 0) |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5722 change_frame_size (f, f->new_text_lines, f->new_text_cols, |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5723 0, 0, safe); |
314 | 5724 } |
5725 } | |
5726 } | |
5727 | |
5728 | |
764 | 5729 /* Change the frame height and/or width. Values may be given as zero to |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5730 indicate no change is to take place. |
314 | 5731 |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5732 If DELAY is non-zero, then assume we're being called from a signal |
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5733 handler, and queue the change for later - perhaps the next |
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5734 redisplay. Since this tries to resize windows, we can't call it |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5735 from a signal handler. |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5736 |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5737 SAFE non-zero means this function is called from a place where it's |
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5738 safe to change frame sizes while a redisplay is in progress. */ |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5739 |
21514 | 5740 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5741 change_frame_size (register struct frame *f, int newheight, int newwidth, int pretend, int delay, int safe) |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5742 { |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5743 Lisp_Object tail, frame; |
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5744 |
53229
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5745 if (FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5746 { |
53229
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5747 /* On MS-DOS, all frames use the same screen, so a change in |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5748 size affects all frames. Termcap now supports multiple |
33c3c7c16e13
lib-src/emacsclient.c: Implemented --here option (open a new Emacs tty). Needs more work.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53226
diff
changeset
|
5749 ttys. */ |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5750 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
15395
b584c2db055f
(change_frame_size, remake_frame_glyphs): Use FRAME_WINDOW_P.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15394
diff
changeset
|
5751 if (! FRAME_WINDOW_P (XFRAME (frame))) |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5752 change_frame_size_1 (XFRAME (frame), newheight, newwidth, |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5753 pretend, delay, safe); |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5754 } |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5755 else |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5756 change_frame_size_1 (f, newheight, newwidth, pretend, delay, safe); |
10770
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5757 } |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5758 |
79745e047484
(change_frame_size_1): New subroutine.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10745
diff
changeset
|
5759 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5760 change_frame_size_1 (register struct frame *f, int newheight, int newwidth, int pretend, int delay, int safe) |
314 | 5761 { |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5762 int new_frame_total_cols; |
46293
1fb8f75062c6
Use macro SPECPDL_INDEX.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
44890
diff
changeset
|
5763 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX (); |
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5764 |
314 | 5765 /* If we can't deal with the change now, queue it for later. */ |
25345
ca828f89fd6e
(do_pending_window_change): Add parameter `safe'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25318
diff
changeset
|
5766 if (delay || (redisplaying_p && !safe)) |
314 | 5767 { |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5768 f->new_text_lines = newheight; |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5769 f->new_text_cols = newwidth; |
314 | 5770 delayed_size_change = 1; |
5771 return; | |
5772 } | |
5773 | |
764 | 5774 /* This size-change overrides any pending one for this frame. */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5775 f->new_text_lines = 0; |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5776 f->new_text_cols = 0; |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5777 |
3449
ad455da9b789
(do_pending_window_change): No need to clear
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
3357
diff
changeset
|
5778 /* If an argument is zero, set it to the current value. */ |
15896
3a3c30116313
(change_frame_size_1): Clean up conditional.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
15687
diff
changeset
|
5779 if (newheight == 0) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5780 newheight = FRAME_LINES (f); |
15896
3a3c30116313
(change_frame_size_1): Clean up conditional.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
15687
diff
changeset
|
5781 if (newwidth == 0) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5782 newwidth = FRAME_COLS (f); |
25012 | 5783 |
5784 /* Compute width of windows in F. | |
5785 This is the width of the frame without vertical scroll bars. */ | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5786 new_frame_total_cols = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS_ARG (f, newwidth); |
16881
245ba9f2781a
(change_frame_size_1): Reject new sizes if they cause overflow.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16822
diff
changeset
|
5787 |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5788 /* Round up to the smallest acceptable size. */ |
25012 | 5789 check_frame_size (f, &newheight, &newwidth); |
960
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5790 |
17986889d3b6
* dispnew.c (Fredraw_frame): Call clear_frame_records before
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
764
diff
changeset
|
5791 /* If we're not changing the frame size, quit now. */ |
106765
0c270bc7ceff
Frame width was not updated in fullscreen when scroll bars where removed/added.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105877
diff
changeset
|
5792 /* Frame width may be unchanged but the text portion may change, for example, |
0c270bc7ceff
Frame width was not updated in fullscreen when scroll bars where removed/added.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105877
diff
changeset
|
5793 fullscreen and remove/add scroll bar. */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5794 if (newheight == FRAME_LINES (f) |
106765
0c270bc7ceff
Frame width was not updated in fullscreen when scroll bars where removed/added.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105877
diff
changeset
|
5795 && newwidth == FRAME_COLS (f) // text portion unchanged |
0c270bc7ceff
Frame width was not updated in fullscreen when scroll bars where removed/added.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105877
diff
changeset
|
5796 && new_frame_total_cols == FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)) // frame width unchanged |
314 | 5797 return; |
5798 | |
15078 | 5799 BLOCK_INPUT; |
5800 | |
14286
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5801 #ifdef MSDOS |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5802 /* We only can set screen dimensions to certain values supported |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5803 by our video hardware. Try to find the smallest size greater |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5804 or equal to the requested dimensions. */ |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5805 dos_set_window_size (&newheight, &newwidth); |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5806 #endif |
5d42664b4e74
(change_frame_size_1) [MSDOS]: Support frame size
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14186
diff
changeset
|
5807 |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5808 if (newheight != FRAME_LINES (f)) |
314 | 5809 { |
25012 | 5810 if (FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f) && !FRAME_MINIBUF_ONLY_P (f)) |
314 | 5811 { |
25012 | 5812 /* Frame has both root and mini-buffer. */ |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5813 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f))->top_line, |
25012 | 5814 FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)); |
5815 set_window_height (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), | |
5816 (newheight | |
5817 - 1 | |
5818 - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f)), | |
94513
5b9bb0c0273a
(change_frame_size_1): Preserve small windows when shrinking
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
92692
diff
changeset
|
5819 2); |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5820 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f))->top_line, |
9303
3115ae493c30
(direct_output_for_insert, direct_output_forward_char, change_frame_size,
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
9264
diff
changeset
|
5821 newheight - 1); |
25012 | 5822 set_window_height (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), 1, 0); |
314 | 5823 } |
5824 else | |
764 | 5825 /* Frame has just one top-level window. */ |
25012 | 5826 set_window_height (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), |
94513
5b9bb0c0273a
(change_frame_size_1): Preserve small windows when shrinking
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
92692
diff
changeset
|
5827 newheight - FRAME_TOP_MARGIN (f), 2); |
25012 | 5828 |
98497
6fa56eeb247c
(change_frame_size_1): Set FrameRows and FrameCols for MSDOS frames as well.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98438
diff
changeset
|
5829 /* MSDOS frames cannot PRETEND, as they change frame size by |
6fa56eeb247c
(change_frame_size_1): Set FrameRows and FrameCols for MSDOS frames as well.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98438
diff
changeset
|
5830 manipulating video hardware. */ |
6fa56eeb247c
(change_frame_size_1): Set FrameRows and FrameCols for MSDOS frames as well.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98438
diff
changeset
|
5831 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) && !pretend) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
53232
22aaf1e5fbe6
Full support for multiple terminal I/O (with some rough edges).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53231
diff
changeset
|
5832 FrameRows (FRAME_TTY (f)) = newheight; |
314 | 5833 } |
5834 | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5835 if (new_frame_total_cols != FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (f)) |
314 | 5836 { |
94513
5b9bb0c0273a
(change_frame_size_1): Preserve small windows when shrinking
Martin Rudalics <rudalics@gmx.at>
parents:
92692
diff
changeset
|
5837 set_window_width (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f), new_frame_total_cols, 2); |
25012 | 5838 if (FRAME_HAS_MINIBUF_P (f)) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5839 set_window_width (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (f), new_frame_total_cols, 0); |
25012 | 5840 |
98497
6fa56eeb247c
(change_frame_size_1): Set FrameRows and FrameCols for MSDOS frames as well.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98438
diff
changeset
|
5841 /* MSDOS frames cannot PRETEND, as they change frame size by |
6fa56eeb247c
(change_frame_size_1): Set FrameRows and FrameCols for MSDOS frames as well.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98438
diff
changeset
|
5842 manipulating video hardware. */ |
6fa56eeb247c
(change_frame_size_1): Set FrameRows and FrameCols for MSDOS frames as well.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98438
diff
changeset
|
5843 if ((FRAME_TERMCAP_P (f) && !pretend) || FRAME_MSDOS_P (f)) |
53232
22aaf1e5fbe6
Full support for multiple terminal I/O (with some rough edges).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53231
diff
changeset
|
5844 FrameCols (FRAME_TTY (f)) = newwidth; |
25012 | 5845 |
25544
693ca9ba497a
Change spelling of `toolbar' to `tool_bar' or `tool-bar'.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25514
diff
changeset
|
5846 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)) |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5847 XSETFASTINT (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)->total_cols, newwidth); |
314 | 5848 } |
5849 | |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5850 FRAME_LINES (f) = newheight; |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
5851 SET_FRAME_COLS (f, newwidth); |
25012 | 5852 |
5853 { | |
5854 struct window *w = XWINDOW (FRAME_SELECTED_WINDOW (f)); | |
5855 int text_area_x, text_area_y, text_area_width, text_area_height; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
5856 |
25012 | 5857 window_box (w, TEXT_AREA, &text_area_x, &text_area_y, &text_area_width, |
5858 &text_area_height); | |
5859 if (w->cursor.x >= text_area_x + text_area_width) | |
5860 w->cursor.hpos = w->cursor.x = 0; | |
5861 if (w->cursor.y >= text_area_y + text_area_height) | |
5862 w->cursor.vpos = w->cursor.y = 0; | |
5863 } | |
5864 | |
5865 adjust_glyphs (f); | |
40512
d256f6fc9c05
(change_frame_size_1): Set frame's resized_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40334
diff
changeset
|
5866 calculate_costs (f); |
25012 | 5867 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
40512
d256f6fc9c05
(change_frame_size_1): Set frame's resized_p.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
40334
diff
changeset
|
5868 f->resized_p = 1; |
15065 | 5869 |
5870 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
17282
5023bea28298
(change_frame_size_1): Call Fset_window_buffer,
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
17015
diff
changeset
|
5871 |
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5872 record_unwind_protect (Fset_buffer, Fcurrent_buffer ()); |
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5873 |
88050
449ffc76e463
* window.c (run_window_configuration_change_hook): New function.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
5874 run_window_configuration_change_hook (f); |
19627
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5875 |
c6343f7a9c6c
(change_frame_size_1): Save current buffer
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19063
diff
changeset
|
5876 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
314 | 5877 } |
25012 | 5878 |
5879 | |
314 | 5880 |
25012 | 5881 /*********************************************************************** |
5882 Terminal Related Lisp Functions | |
5883 ***********************************************************************/ | |
5884 | |
5885 DEFUN ("open-termscript", Fopen_termscript, Sopen_termscript, | |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
5886 1, 1, "FOpen termscript file: ", |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5887 doc: /* Start writing all terminal output to FILE as well as the terminal. |
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5888 FILE = nil means just close any termscript file currently open. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
5889 (Lisp_Object file) |
25012 | 5890 { |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5891 struct tty_display_info *tty; |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5892 |
98508
c370f470d5ba
(update_frame): Flush termscript for MSDOS frames as well as for TTY.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98497
diff
changeset
|
5893 if (! FRAME_TERMCAP_P (SELECTED_FRAME ()) |
c370f470d5ba
(update_frame): Flush termscript for MSDOS frames as well as for TTY.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
98497
diff
changeset
|
5894 && ! FRAME_MSDOS_P (SELECTED_FRAME ())) |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5895 error ("Current frame is not on a tty device"); |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5896 |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5897 tty = CURTTY (); |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5898 |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5899 if (tty->termscript != 0) |
83560 | 5900 { |
5901 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5902 fclose (tty->termscript); |
83560 | 5903 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
5904 } | |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5905 tty->termscript = 0; |
25012 | 5906 |
5907 if (! NILP (file)) | |
5908 { | |
5909 file = Fexpand_file_name (file, Qnil); | |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5910 tty->termscript = fopen (SDATA (file), "w"); |
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5911 if (tty->termscript == 0) |
25012 | 5912 report_file_error ("Opening termscript", Fcons (file, Qnil)); |
5913 } | |
5914 return Qnil; | |
5915 } | |
5916 | |
5917 | |
314 | 5918 DEFUN ("send-string-to-terminal", Fsend_string_to_terminal, |
83370
5272862a4865
Fix crashes in xdialog_show (and other places) with xterm-mouse-mode.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83362
diff
changeset
|
5919 Ssend_string_to_terminal, 1, 2, 0, |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5920 doc: /* Send STRING to the terminal without alteration. |
83370
5272862a4865
Fix crashes in xdialog_show (and other places) with xterm-mouse-mode.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83362
diff
changeset
|
5921 Control characters in STRING will have terminal-dependent effects. |
5272862a4865
Fix crashes in xdialog_show (and other places) with xterm-mouse-mode.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83362
diff
changeset
|
5922 |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
5923 Optional parameter TERMINAL specifies the tty terminal device to use. |
104957
81757111b576
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Amend doc string to cover batch mode.
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
104816
diff
changeset
|
5924 It may be a terminal object, a frame, or nil for the terminal used by |
81757111b576
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Amend doc string to cover batch mode.
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
104816
diff
changeset
|
5925 the currently selected frame. In batch mode, STRING is sent to stdout |
81757111b576
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Amend doc string to cover batch mode.
Alan Mackenzie <acm@muc.de>
parents:
104816
diff
changeset
|
5926 when TERMINAL is nil. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
5927 (Lisp_Object string, Lisp_Object terminal) |
314 | 5928 { |
104816
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5929 struct terminal *t = get_terminal (terminal, 1); |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5930 FILE *out; |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5931 |
20618
d5acac3af6e3
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Use size_byte.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19627
diff
changeset
|
5932 /* ??? Perhaps we should do something special for multibyte strings here. */ |
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
5933 CHECK_STRING (string); |
76621
685fa6c9ae44
(Fopen_termscript): Add BLOCK_INPUT around fclose.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
76069
diff
changeset
|
5934 BLOCK_INPUT; |
83065
a871be7b26a5
Implemented suspending of emacsclient frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83037
diff
changeset
|
5935 |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
5936 if (!t) |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
5937 error ("Unknown terminal device"); |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
5938 |
104816
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5939 if (t->type == output_initial) |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5940 out = stdout; |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5941 else if (t->type != output_termcap && t->type != output_msdos_raw) |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5942 error ("Device %d is not a termcap terminal device", t->id); |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5943 else |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5944 { |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5945 struct tty_display_info *tty = t->display_info.tty; |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5946 |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5947 if (! tty->output) |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5948 error ("Terminal is currently suspended"); |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5949 |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5950 if (tty->termscript) |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5951 { |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5952 fwrite (SDATA (string), 1, SBYTES (string), tty->termscript); |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5953 fflush (tty->termscript); |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5954 } |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5955 out = tty->output; |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5956 } |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5957 fwrite (SDATA (string), 1, SBYTES (string), out); |
4129eea9d003
(Fsend_string_to_terminal): Make it work again on the initial terminal as well.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
104077
diff
changeset
|
5958 fflush (out); |
76621
685fa6c9ae44
(Fopen_termscript): Add BLOCK_INPUT around fclose.
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
76069
diff
changeset
|
5959 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
314 | 5960 return Qnil; |
5961 } | |
5962 | |
25012 | 5963 |
314 | 5964 DEFUN ("ding", Fding, Sding, 0, 1, 0, |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5965 doc: /* Beep, or flash the screen. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
5966 Also, unless an argument is given, |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
5967 terminate any keyboard macro currently executing. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
5968 (Lisp_Object arg) |
314 | 5969 { |
493 | 5970 if (!NILP (arg)) |
314 | 5971 { |
649
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
5972 if (noninteractive) |
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
5973 putchar (07); |
61deba7b73b6
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
587
diff
changeset
|
5974 else |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5975 ring_bell (XFRAME (selected_frame)); |
314 | 5976 } |
5977 else | |
5978 bitch_at_user (); | |
5979 | |
5980 return Qnil; | |
5981 } | |
5982 | |
21514 | 5983 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
5984 bitch_at_user (void) |
314 | 5985 { |
5986 if (noninteractive) | |
5987 putchar (07); | |
25012 | 5988 else if (!INTERACTIVE) /* Stop executing a keyboard macro. */ |
314 | 5989 error ("Keyboard macro terminated by a command ringing the bell"); |
5990 else | |
83100
4970ad4995f5
Eliminated updating_frame.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83098
diff
changeset
|
5991 ring_bell (XFRAME (selected_frame)); |
314 | 5992 } |
5993 | |
25012 | 5994 |
5995 | |
5996 /*********************************************************************** | |
5997 Sleeping, Waiting | |
5998 ***********************************************************************/ | |
5999 | |
314 | 6000 DEFUN ("sleep-for", Fsleep_for, Ssleep_for, 1, 2, 0, |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6001 doc: /* Pause, without updating display, for SECONDS seconds. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6002 SECONDS may be a floating-point value, meaning that you can wait for a |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6003 fraction of a second. Optional second arg MILLISECONDS specifies an |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6004 additional wait period, in milliseconds; this may be useful if your |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6005 Emacs was built without floating point support. |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6006 \(Not all operating systems support waiting for a fraction of a second.) */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
6007 (Lisp_Object seconds, Lisp_Object milliseconds) |
314 | 6008 { |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6009 int sec, usec; |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6010 |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6011 if (NILP (milliseconds)) |
9264
9338a124ea84
(redraw_frame, Fsleep_for, sit_for, Fsit_for): Use new accessor macros instead
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
8903
diff
changeset
|
6012 XSETINT (milliseconds, 0); |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6013 else |
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6014 CHECK_NUMBER (milliseconds); |
2648 | 6015 usec = XINT (milliseconds) * 1000; |
6016 | |
6017 { | |
6018 double duration = extract_float (seconds); | |
6019 sec = (int) duration; | |
6020 usec += (duration - sec) * 1000000; | |
6021 } | |
314 | 6022 |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6023 #ifndef EMACS_HAS_USECS |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6024 if (sec == 0 && usec != 0) |
63695
98563021d2e3
(Fsleep_for, Fsit_for): Follow error conventions.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
63649
diff
changeset
|
6025 error ("Millisecond `sleep-for' not supported on %s", SYSTEM_TYPE); |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6026 #endif |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6027 |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6028 /* Assure that 0 <= usec < 1000000. */ |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6029 if (usec < 0) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6030 { |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
6031 /* We can't rely on the rounding being correct if usec is negative. */ |
2291
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6032 if (-1000000 < usec) |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6033 sec--, usec += 1000000; |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6034 else |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6035 sec -= -usec / 1000000, usec = 1000000 - (-usec % 1000000); |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6036 } |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6037 else |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6038 sec += usec / 1000000, usec %= 1000000; |
bee5c1693cac
* dispnew.c (Fsleep_for): Make this take two arguments SECONDS and
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2288
diff
changeset
|
6039 |
14646
68fe10d1abd0
(Fsleep_for): Accept sub-second intervals.
Erik Naggum <erik@naggum.no>
parents:
14459
diff
changeset
|
6040 if (sec < 0 || (sec == 0 && usec == 0)) |
314 | 6041 return Qnil; |
6042 | |
56727
6b028bf60b4e
(Fsleep_for): Remove obsolete code.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
56717
diff
changeset
|
6043 wait_reading_process_output (sec, usec, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0); |
314 | 6044 |
6045 return Qnil; | |
6046 } | |
6047 | |
25012 | 6048 |
56727
6b028bf60b4e
(Fsleep_for): Remove obsolete code.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
56717
diff
changeset
|
6049 /* This is just like wait_reading_process_output, except that |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6050 it does redisplay. |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6051 |
73318
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6052 TIMEOUT is number of seconds to wait (float or integer), |
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6053 or t to wait forever. |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6054 READING is 1 if reading input. |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6055 If DO_DISPLAY is >0 display process output while waiting. |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6056 If DO_DISPLAY is >1 perform an initial redisplay before waiting. |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6057 */ |
650 | 6058 |
6059 Lisp_Object | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
6060 sit_for (Lisp_Object timeout, int reading, int do_display) |
314 | 6061 { |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6062 int sec, usec; |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6063 |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6064 swallow_events (do_display); |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6065 |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6066 if ((detect_input_pending_run_timers (do_display)) |
71138
5cf77229c85d
(sit_for): Perform redisplay even if input is pending
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
70300
diff
changeset
|
6067 || !NILP (Vexecuting_kbd_macro)) |
314 | 6068 return Qnil; |
650 | 6069 |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6070 if (do_display >= 2) |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6071 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (2); |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6072 |
71804
1a7b37f82a06
(sit_for): Signal error if TIMEOUT is not a number in case arg comes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71794
diff
changeset
|
6073 if (INTEGERP (timeout)) |
71333
a8cbcce39bd0
(sit_for): Undo 2006-06-01 change. Instead, a
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71323
diff
changeset
|
6074 { |
71810 | 6075 sec = XINT (timeout); |
71804
1a7b37f82a06
(sit_for): Signal error if TIMEOUT is not a number in case arg comes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71794
diff
changeset
|
6076 usec = 0; |
1a7b37f82a06
(sit_for): Signal error if TIMEOUT is not a number in case arg comes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71794
diff
changeset
|
6077 } |
1a7b37f82a06
(sit_for): Signal error if TIMEOUT is not a number in case arg comes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71794
diff
changeset
|
6078 else if (FLOATP (timeout)) |
1a7b37f82a06
(sit_for): Signal error if TIMEOUT is not a number in case arg comes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71794
diff
changeset
|
6079 { |
71831
347f809d2edb
(sit_for): Tiny simplification.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71810
diff
changeset
|
6080 double seconds = XFLOAT_DATA (timeout); |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6081 sec = (int) seconds; |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6082 usec = (int) ((seconds - sec) * 1000000); |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6083 } |
73318
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6084 else if (EQ (timeout, Qt)) |
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6085 { |
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6086 sec = 0; |
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6087 usec = 0; |
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6088 } |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6089 else |
71804
1a7b37f82a06
(sit_for): Signal error if TIMEOUT is not a number in case arg comes
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71794
diff
changeset
|
6090 wrong_type_argument (Qnumberp, timeout); |
314 | 6091 |
73318
e876a1f62fec
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Sit forever if TIMEOUT is t.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
72949
diff
changeset
|
6092 if (sec == 0 && usec == 0 && !EQ (timeout, Qt)) |
673 | 6093 return Qt; |
6094 | |
314 | 6095 #ifdef SIGIO |
1915
98ecf99d7b1a
* dispnew.c (sit_for): Pass the correct number of arguments to
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
1872
diff
changeset
|
6096 gobble_input (0); |
650 | 6097 #endif |
6098 | |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6099 wait_reading_process_output (sec, usec, reading ? -1 : 1, do_display, |
56727
6b028bf60b4e
(Fsleep_for): Remove obsolete code.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
56717
diff
changeset
|
6100 Qnil, NULL, 0); |
650 | 6101 |
314 | 6102 return detect_input_pending () ? Qnil : Qt; |
6103 } | |
6104 | |
25012 | 6105 |
71771
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6106 DEFUN ("redisplay", Fredisplay, Sredisplay, 0, 1, 0, |
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6107 doc: /* Perform redisplay if no input is available. |
71773 | 6108 If optional arg FORCE is non-nil or `redisplay-dont-pause' is non-nil, |
72788
102f29870373
(Fredisplay): Document return value.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71946
diff
changeset
|
6109 perform a full redisplay even if input is available. |
102f29870373
(Fredisplay): Document return value.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71946
diff
changeset
|
6110 Return t if redisplay was performed, nil otherwise. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
6111 (Lisp_Object force) |
650 | 6112 { |
71771
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6113 int count; |
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6114 |
71794
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6115 swallow_events (1); |
d76f16a63bf2
(sit_for): Reduce number of args from 5 to 3.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71773
diff
changeset
|
6116 if ((detect_input_pending_run_timers (1) |
71771
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6117 && NILP (force) && !redisplay_dont_pause) |
71761
1055c0769159
* puresize.h (BASE_PURESIZE): Increment to 1211000.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
71573
diff
changeset
|
6118 || !NILP (Vexecuting_kbd_macro)) |
1055c0769159
* puresize.h (BASE_PURESIZE): Increment to 1211000.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
71573
diff
changeset
|
6119 return Qnil; |
1055c0769159
* puresize.h (BASE_PURESIZE): Increment to 1211000.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
71573
diff
changeset
|
6120 |
71771
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6121 count = SPECPDL_INDEX (); |
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6122 if (!NILP (force) && !redisplay_dont_pause) |
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6123 specbind (Qredisplay_dont_pause, Qt); |
71761
1055c0769159
* puresize.h (BASE_PURESIZE): Increment to 1211000.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
71573
diff
changeset
|
6124 redisplay_preserve_echo_area (2); |
71771
c6e0c9217129
(Fredisplay): Add FORCE argument to force redisplay when
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71761
diff
changeset
|
6125 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
71761
1055c0769159
* puresize.h (BASE_PURESIZE): Increment to 1211000.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
71573
diff
changeset
|
6126 return Qt; |
650 | 6127 } |
25012 | 6128 |
6129 | |
314 | 6130 |
25012 | 6131 /*********************************************************************** |
6132 Other Lisp Functions | |
6133 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6134 | |
6135 /* A vector of size >= 2 * NFRAMES + 3 * NBUFFERS + 1, containing the | |
6136 session's frames, frame names, buffers, buffer-read-only flags, and | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6137 buffer-modified-flags. */ |
25012 | 6138 |
6139 static Lisp_Object frame_and_buffer_state; | |
6140 | |
6141 | |
6142 DEFUN ("frame-or-buffer-changed-p", Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p, | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6143 Sframe_or_buffer_changed_p, 0, 1, 0, |
40979 | 6144 doc: /* Return non-nil if the frame and buffer state appears to have changed. |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6145 VARIABLE is a variable name whose value is either nil or a state vector |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6146 that will be updated to contain all frames and buffers, |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6147 aside from buffers whose names start with space, |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6148 along with the buffers' read-only and modified flags. This allows a fast |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6149 check to see whether buffer menus might need to be recomputed. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6150 If this function returns non-nil, it updates the internal vector to reflect |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6151 the current state. |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6152 |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6153 If VARIABLE is nil, an internal variable is used. Users should not |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6154 pass nil for VARIABLE. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
6155 (Lisp_Object variable) |
25012 | 6156 { |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6157 Lisp_Object state, tail, frame, buf; |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6158 Lisp_Object *vecp, *end; |
25012 | 6159 int n; |
6160 | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6161 if (! NILP (variable)) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6162 { |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6163 CHECK_SYMBOL (variable); |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6164 state = Fsymbol_value (variable); |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6165 if (! VECTORP (state)) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6166 goto changed; |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6167 } |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6168 else |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6169 state = frame_and_buffer_state; |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6170 |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6171 vecp = XVECTOR (state)->contents; |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6172 end = vecp + XVECTOR (state)->size; |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6173 |
25012 | 6174 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
6175 { | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6176 if (vecp == end) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6177 goto changed; |
25012 | 6178 if (!EQ (*vecp++, frame)) |
6179 goto changed; | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6180 if (vecp == end) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6181 goto changed; |
25012 | 6182 if (!EQ (*vecp++, XFRAME (frame)->name)) |
6183 goto changed; | |
6184 } | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6185 /* Check that the buffer info matches. */ |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6186 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
25012 | 6187 { |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6188 buf = XCDR (XCAR (tail)); |
25012 | 6189 /* Ignore buffers that aren't included in buffer lists. */ |
46370
40db0673e6f0
Most uses of XSTRING combined with STRING_BYTES or indirection changed to
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
46293
diff
changeset
|
6190 if (SREF (XBUFFER (buf)->name, 0) == ' ') |
25012 | 6191 continue; |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6192 if (vecp == end) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6193 goto changed; |
25012 | 6194 if (!EQ (*vecp++, buf)) |
6195 goto changed; | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6196 if (vecp == end) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6197 goto changed; |
25012 | 6198 if (!EQ (*vecp++, XBUFFER (buf)->read_only)) |
6199 goto changed; | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6200 if (vecp == end) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6201 goto changed; |
25012 | 6202 if (!EQ (*vecp++, Fbuffer_modified_p (buf))) |
6203 goto changed; | |
6204 } | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6205 if (vecp == end) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6206 goto changed; |
25012 | 6207 /* Detect deletion of a buffer at the end of the list. */ |
6208 if (EQ (*vecp, Qlambda)) | |
6209 return Qnil; | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6210 |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6211 /* Come here if we decide the data has changed. */ |
25012 | 6212 changed: |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6213 /* Count the size we will need. |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6214 Start with 1 so there is room for at least one lambda at the end. */ |
25012 | 6215 n = 1; |
6216 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) | |
6217 n += 2; | |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6218 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
25012 | 6219 n += 3; |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6220 /* Reallocate the vector if data has grown to need it, |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6221 or if it has shrunk a lot. */ |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6222 if (! VECTORP (state) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6223 || n > XVECTOR (state)->size |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6224 || n + 20 < XVECTOR (state)->size / 2) |
25012 | 6225 /* Add 20 extra so we grow it less often. */ |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6226 { |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6227 state = Fmake_vector (make_number (n + 20), Qlambda); |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6228 if (! NILP (variable)) |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6229 Fset (variable, state); |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6230 else |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6231 frame_and_buffer_state = state; |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6232 } |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6233 |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6234 /* Record the new data in the (possibly reallocated) vector. */ |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6235 vecp = XVECTOR (state)->contents; |
25012 | 6236 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame) |
6237 { | |
6238 *vecp++ = frame; | |
6239 *vecp++ = XFRAME (frame)->name; | |
6240 } | |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6241 for (tail = Vbuffer_alist; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail)) |
25012 | 6242 { |
26164
d39ec0a27081
more XCAR/XCDR/XFLOAT_DATA uses, to help isolete lisp engine
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
26088
diff
changeset
|
6243 buf = XCDR (XCAR (tail)); |
25012 | 6244 /* Ignore buffers that aren't included in buffer lists. */ |
46370
40db0673e6f0
Most uses of XSTRING combined with STRING_BYTES or indirection changed to
Ken Raeburn <raeburn@raeburn.org>
parents:
46293
diff
changeset
|
6245 if (SREF (XBUFFER (buf)->name, 0) == ' ') |
25012 | 6246 continue; |
6247 *vecp++ = buf; | |
6248 *vecp++ = XBUFFER (buf)->read_only; | |
6249 *vecp++ = Fbuffer_modified_p (buf); | |
6250 } | |
6251 /* Fill up the vector with lambdas (always at least one). */ | |
6252 *vecp++ = Qlambda; | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6253 while (vecp - XVECTOR (state)->contents |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6254 < XVECTOR (state)->size) |
25012 | 6255 *vecp++ = Qlambda; |
6256 /* Make sure we didn't overflow the vector. */ | |
64776
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6257 if (vecp - XVECTOR (state)->contents |
42f593faa113
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Take an arg
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
6258 > XVECTOR (state)->size) |
25012 | 6259 abort (); |
6260 return Qt; | |
6261 } | |
6262 | |
6263 | |
6264 | |
6265 /*********************************************************************** | |
6266 Initialization | |
6267 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6268 | |
6269 /* Initialization done when Emacs fork is started, before doing stty. | |
6270 Determine terminal type and set terminal_driver. Then invoke its | |
6271 decoding routine to set up variables in the terminal package. */ | |
314 | 6272 |
21514 | 6273 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
6274 init_display (void) |
314 | 6275 { |
53226
dd3018b4785b
Implemented multiple tty support.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53225
diff
changeset
|
6276 char *terminal_type; |
dd3018b4785b
Implemented multiple tty support.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
53225
diff
changeset
|
6277 |
25012 | 6278 /* Construct the space glyph. */ |
6279 space_glyph.type = CHAR_GLYPH; | |
92276
1dc7b04a4d95
(line_draw_cost): Adapt to new glyph type.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
91367
diff
changeset
|
6280 SET_CHAR_GLYPH (space_glyph, ' ', DEFAULT_FACE_ID, 0); |
25012 | 6281 space_glyph.charpos = -1; |
6282 | |
314 | 6283 inverse_video = 0; |
6284 cursor_in_echo_area = 0; | |
6285 terminal_type = (char *) 0; | |
6286 | |
2339
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6287 /* Now is the time to initialize this; it's used by init_sys_modes |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6288 during startup. */ |
83014
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
6289 Vinitial_window_system = Qnil; |
314 | 6290 |
83146
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6291 /* SIGWINCH needs to be handled no matter what display we start |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6292 with. Otherwise newly opened tty frames will not resize |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6293 automatically. */ |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6294 #ifdef SIGWINCH |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6295 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6296 if (initialized) |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6297 #endif /* CANNOT_DUMP */ |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6298 signal (SIGWINCH, window_change_signal); |
3708519cf113
Make sure the SIGWINCH handler is always set (rep. by Yoshiaki Kasahara).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83112
diff
changeset
|
6299 #endif /* SIGWINCH */ |
314 | 6300 |
98379
7424f5df0da7
(init_display): Return earlier when running as a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
98327
diff
changeset
|
6301 /* If running as a daemon, no need to initialize any frames/terminal. */ |
99182
c1511154e8c2
* emacs.c (daemon_pipe): Make non-static.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
98589
diff
changeset
|
6302 if (IS_DAEMON) |
c1511154e8c2
* emacs.c (daemon_pipe): Make non-static.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
98589
diff
changeset
|
6303 return; |
98379
7424f5df0da7
(init_display): Return earlier when running as a
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
98327
diff
changeset
|
6304 |
2339
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6305 /* If the user wants to use a window system, we shouldn't bother |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6306 initializing the terminal. This is especially important when the |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6307 terminal is so dumb that emacs gives up before and doesn't bother |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6308 using the window system. |
a302de11debf
* dispnew.c (init_display): Initialize Vwindow_system.
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2292
diff
changeset
|
6309 |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6310 If the DISPLAY environment variable is set and nonempty, |
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6311 try to use X, and die with an error message if that doesn't work. */ |
314 | 6312 |
6313 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS | |
69952
b9da898695a5
* dispnew.c (init_display): Don't init X display if the user asked
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69607
diff
changeset
|
6314 if (! inhibit_window_system && ! display_arg) |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6315 { |
14125
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6316 char *display; |
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6317 display = getenv ("DISPLAY"); |
2f222e8b06f5
(init_display): Treat null string DISPLAY var like not set.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
14068
diff
changeset
|
6318 display_arg = (display != 0 && *display != 0); |
69607
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6319 |
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6320 if (display_arg && !x_display_ok (display)) |
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6321 { |
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6322 fprintf (stderr, "Display %s unavailable, simulating -nw\n", |
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6323 display); |
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6324 inhibit_window_system = 1; |
761eaec1aae4
* dispnew.c (init_display): Check DISPLAY here.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
69110
diff
changeset
|
6325 } |
2364 | 6326 } |
2359
90a5f91329f3
* dispnew.c (init_display): Get display name from environment
Jim Blandy <jimb@redhat.com>
parents:
2339
diff
changeset
|
6327 |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6328 if (!inhibit_window_system && display_arg |
18774
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6329 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6330 && initialized |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6331 #endif |
95b4ac950a5d
(init_display): Go ahead and prepare for
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18015
diff
changeset
|
6332 ) |
314 | 6333 { |
104077
3abca9a8122f
* dispnew.c (init_display): Use Qx, Qw32, and Qns.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103052
diff
changeset
|
6334 Vinitial_window_system = Qx; |
314 | 6335 #ifdef HAVE_X11 |
6336 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (11); | |
6337 #endif | |
41969
e669966d496e
Test GNU_LINUX, not LINUX.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
41120
diff
changeset
|
6338 #if defined (GNU_LINUX) && defined (HAVE_LIBNCURSES) |
15273
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6339 /* In some versions of ncurses, |
15282 | 6340 tputs crashes if we have not called tgetent. |
15273
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6341 So call tgetent. */ |
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6342 { char b[2044]; tgetent (b, "xterm");} |
db889dd732a1
(init_display) [HAVE_LIBNCURSES]: If X, call tgetent.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
15078
diff
changeset
|
6343 #endif |
25012 | 6344 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
314 | 6345 return; |
6346 } | |
6347 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */ | |
6348 | |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6349 #ifdef HAVE_NTGUI |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6350 if (!inhibit_window_system) |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6351 { |
104077
3abca9a8122f
* dispnew.c (init_display): Use Qx, Qw32, and Qns.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103052
diff
changeset
|
6352 Vinitial_window_system = Qw32; |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6353 Vwindow_system_version = make_number (1); |
25012 | 6354 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
13408
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6355 return; |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6356 } |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6357 #endif /* HAVE_NTGUI */ |
7e92386e1cf7
[HAVE_NTGUI]: Include w32term.h.
Geoff Voelker <voelker@cs.washington.edu>
parents:
13220
diff
changeset
|
6358 |
96675
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6359 #ifdef HAVE_NS |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6360 if (!inhibit_window_system |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6361 #ifndef CANNOT_DUMP |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6362 && initialized |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6363 #endif |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6364 ) |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6365 { |
104077
3abca9a8122f
* dispnew.c (init_display): Use Qx, Qw32, and Qns.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103052
diff
changeset
|
6366 Vinitial_window_system = Qns; |
96675
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6367 Vwindow_system_version = make_number(10); |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6368 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6369 return; |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6370 } |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6371 #endif |
d45acf0c8d23
merging Emacs.app (NeXTstep port)
Adrian Robert <Adrian.B.Robert@gmail.com>
parents:
96236
diff
changeset
|
6372 |
314 | 6373 /* If no window system has been specified, try to use the terminal. */ |
6374 if (! isatty (0)) | |
6375 { | |
16896
b2c51d6de440
(init_display): Use `fatal'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16891
diff
changeset
|
6376 fatal ("standard input is not a tty"); |
314 | 6377 exit (1); |
6378 } | |
6379 | |
86273
77b991c8303d
(init_display) [WINDOWSNT]: Hardcode terminal_type.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
85826
diff
changeset
|
6380 #ifdef WINDOWSNT |
77b991c8303d
(init_display) [WINDOWSNT]: Hardcode terminal_type.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
85826
diff
changeset
|
6381 terminal_type = "w32console"; |
77b991c8303d
(init_display) [WINDOWSNT]: Hardcode terminal_type.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
85826
diff
changeset
|
6382 #else |
42835
38f2be5a65fd
(update_frame): Move the variable `tem' to the block where it is used.
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
41969
diff
changeset
|
6383 /* Look at the TERM variable. */ |
314 | 6384 terminal_type = (char *) getenv ("TERM"); |
86273
77b991c8303d
(init_display) [WINDOWSNT]: Hardcode terminal_type.
Jason Rumney <jasonr@gnu.org>
parents:
85826
diff
changeset
|
6385 #endif |
314 | 6386 if (!terminal_type) |
6387 { | |
71946 | 6388 #ifdef HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM |
71945 | 6389 if (! inhibit_window_system) |
6390 fprintf (stderr, "Please set the environment variable DISPLAY or TERM (see `tset').\n"); | |
71944
270a672fc28c
(init_display): Mention DISPLAY as well as TERM in err msg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
71831
diff
changeset
|
6391 else |
270a672fc28c
(init_display): Mention DISPLAY as well as TERM in err msg.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
71831
diff
changeset
|
6392 #endif /* HAVE_WINDOW_SYSTEM */ |
71945 | 6393 fprintf (stderr, "Please set the environment variable TERM; see `tset'.\n"); |
314 | 6394 exit (1); |
6395 } | |
6396 | |
53341 | 6397 { |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6398 struct terminal *t; |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
6399 struct frame *f = XFRAME (selected_frame); |
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
6400 |
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
6401 /* Open a display on the controlling tty. */ |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6402 t = init_tty (0, terminal_type, 1); /* Errors are fatal. */ |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
6403 |
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
6404 /* Convert the initial frame to use the new display. */ |
83090
72c2a3eb27da
Trivial cosmetic change in dispnew.c.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83074
diff
changeset
|
6405 if (f->output_method != output_initial) |
83008
040dd41ed7d0
Hookified termcap devices, added bootstrap display device, plus many bugfixes.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83004
diff
changeset
|
6406 abort (); |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6407 f->output_method = t->type; |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6408 f->terminal = t; |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6409 |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6410 t->reference_count++; |
111345
8ed4db9b46e6
Fix mouse redesigned mouse highlight on MSDOS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111339
diff
changeset
|
6411 #ifdef MSDOS |
8ed4db9b46e6
Fix mouse redesigned mouse highlight on MSDOS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111339
diff
changeset
|
6412 f->output_data.tty->display_info = &the_only_display_info; |
8ed4db9b46e6
Fix mouse redesigned mouse highlight on MSDOS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111339
diff
changeset
|
6413 #else |
8ed4db9b46e6
Fix mouse redesigned mouse highlight on MSDOS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111339
diff
changeset
|
6414 if (f->output_method == output_termcap) |
8ed4db9b46e6
Fix mouse redesigned mouse highlight on MSDOS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111339
diff
changeset
|
6415 create_tty_output (f); |
8ed4db9b46e6
Fix mouse redesigned mouse highlight on MSDOS.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
111339
diff
changeset
|
6416 #endif |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6417 t->display_info.tty->top_frame = selected_frame; |
83362
c3dd82172ed1
Enforce the presence of `window-system' and `tty-type' frame parameters in all frames.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83353
diff
changeset
|
6418 change_frame_size (XFRAME (selected_frame), |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6419 FrameRows (t->display_info.tty), |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6420 FrameCols (t->display_info.tty), 0, 0, 1); |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6421 |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6422 /* Delete the initial terminal. */ |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6423 if (--initial_terminal->reference_count == 0 |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6424 && initial_terminal->delete_terminal_hook) |
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6425 (*initial_terminal->delete_terminal_hook) (initial_terminal); |
83074
34a7a8f40548
Fix background-mode on terminal frames (Dan Nicolaescu).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83067
diff
changeset
|
6426 |
34a7a8f40548
Fix background-mode on terminal frames (Dan Nicolaescu).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83067
diff
changeset
|
6427 /* Update frame parameters to reflect the new type. */ |
34a7a8f40548
Fix background-mode on terminal frames (Dan Nicolaescu).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83067
diff
changeset
|
6428 Fmodify_frame_parameters |
34a7a8f40548
Fix background-mode on terminal frames (Dan Nicolaescu).
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83067
diff
changeset
|
6429 (selected_frame, Fcons (Fcons (Qtty_type, |
83431
76396de7f50a
Rename `struct device' to `struct terminal'. Rename some terminal-related functions similarly.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83413
diff
changeset
|
6430 Ftty_type (selected_frame)), Qnil)); |
97867
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6431 if (t->display_info.tty->name) |
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6432 Fmodify_frame_parameters (selected_frame, |
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6433 Fcons (Fcons (Qtty, build_string (t->display_info.tty->name)), |
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6434 Qnil)); |
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6435 else |
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6436 Fmodify_frame_parameters (selected_frame, Fcons (Fcons (Qtty, Qnil), |
2aa441279c89
(init_display): Set `tty's association in frame's parameters alist to the name
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
97646
diff
changeset
|
6437 Qnil)); |
53341 | 6438 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6439 |
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6440 { |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6441 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME (); |
51193
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
6442 int width = FRAME_TOTAL_COLS (sf); |
d47b56221a15
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50589
diff
changeset
|
6443 int height = FRAME_LINES (sf); |
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6444 |
25012 | 6445 unsigned int total_glyphs = height * (width + 2) * sizeof (struct glyph); |
6446 | |
6447 /* If these sizes are so big they cause overflow, just ignore the | |
6448 change. It's not clear what better we could do. */ | |
6449 if (total_glyphs / sizeof (struct glyph) / height != width + 2) | |
16896
b2c51d6de440
(init_display): Use `fatal'.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16891
diff
changeset
|
6450 fatal ("screen size %dx%d too big", width, height); |
16891
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6451 } |
989845750a4d
(init_display): Check for overflow in screen size.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16881
diff
changeset
|
6452 |
25012 | 6453 adjust_frame_glyphs_initially (); |
25666
063da8f6a487
(selected_frame): Make it a Lisp_Object.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
25546
diff
changeset
|
6454 calculate_costs (XFRAME (selected_frame)); |
314 | 6455 |
25012 | 6456 /* Set up faces of the initial terminal frame of a dumped Emacs. */ |
6457 if (initialized | |
6458 && !noninteractive | |
83014
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
6459 && NILP (Vinitial_window_system)) |
26729
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6460 { |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6461 /* For the initial frame, we don't have any way of knowing what |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6462 are the foreground and background colors of the terminal. */ |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6463 struct frame *sf = SELECTED_FRAME(); |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6464 |
26902
264b83a3a688
Changes for separate unspecified foreground and background colors
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26851
diff
changeset
|
6465 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (sf) = FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_FG_COLOR; |
264b83a3a688
Changes for separate unspecified foreground and background colors
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26851
diff
changeset
|
6466 FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (sf) = FACE_TTY_DEFAULT_BG_COLOR; |
26729
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6467 call0 (intern ("tty-set-up-initial-frame-faces")); |
f5dded41adcc
Changes for automatic remapping of X colors on terminal frames:
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
26591
diff
changeset
|
6468 } |
314 | 6469 } |
25012 | 6470 |
6471 | |
314 | 6472 |
25012 | 6473 /*********************************************************************** |
6474 Blinking cursor | |
6475 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6476 | |
26280
083835afced5
(Finternal_show_cursor): Renamed from Fshow_cursor.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26164
diff
changeset
|
6477 DEFUN ("internal-show-cursor", Finternal_show_cursor, |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6478 Sinternal_show_cursor, 2, 2, 0, |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6479 doc: /* Set the cursor-visibility flag of WINDOW to SHOW. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6480 WINDOW nil means use the selected window. SHOW non-nil means |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6481 show a cursor in WINDOW in the next redisplay. SHOW nil means |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6482 don't show a cursor. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
6483 (Lisp_Object window, Lisp_Object show) |
25012 | 6484 { |
6485 /* Don't change cursor state while redisplaying. This could confuse | |
6486 output routines. */ | |
6487 if (!redisplaying_p) | |
6488 { | |
6489 if (NILP (window)) | |
6490 window = selected_window; | |
6491 else | |
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6492 CHECK_WINDOW (window); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6493 |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6494 XWINDOW (window)->cursor_off_p = NILP (show); |
25012 | 6495 } |
6496 | |
6497 return Qnil; | |
6498 } | |
6499 | |
6500 | |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6501 DEFUN ("internal-show-cursor-p", Finternal_show_cursor_p, |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6502 Sinternal_show_cursor_p, 0, 1, 0, |
40979 | 6503 doc: /* Value is non-nil if next redisplay will display a cursor in WINDOW. |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6504 WINDOW nil or omitted means report on the selected window. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
6505 (Lisp_Object window) |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6506 { |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6507 struct window *w; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6508 |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6509 if (NILP (window)) |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6510 window = selected_window; |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6511 else |
40656
cdfd4d09b79a
Update usage of CHECK_ macros (remove unused second argument).
Pavel Janík <Pavel@Janik.cz>
parents:
40512
diff
changeset
|
6512 CHECK_WINDOW (window); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6513 |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6514 w = XWINDOW (window); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6515 return w->cursor_off_p ? Qnil : Qt; |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6516 } |
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6517 |
95590
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6518 DEFUN ("last-nonminibuffer-frame", Flast_nonminibuf_frame, |
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6519 Slast_nonminibuf_frame, 0, 0, 0, |
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6520 doc: /* Value is last nonminibuffer frame. */) |
109179
8cfee7d2955f
Convert DEFUNs to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109165
diff
changeset
|
6521 (void) |
95590
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6522 { |
95639
2c12b44a3dfc
(Flast_nonminibuf_frame): Handle the NULL case.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
95590
diff
changeset
|
6523 Lisp_Object frame = Qnil; |
2c12b44a3dfc
(Flast_nonminibuf_frame): Handle the NULL case.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
95590
diff
changeset
|
6524 |
2c12b44a3dfc
(Flast_nonminibuf_frame): Handle the NULL case.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
95590
diff
changeset
|
6525 if (last_nonminibuf_frame) |
2c12b44a3dfc
(Flast_nonminibuf_frame): Handle the NULL case.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
95590
diff
changeset
|
6526 XSETFRAME (frame, last_nonminibuf_frame); |
95590
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6527 |
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6528 return frame; |
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6529 } |
25012 | 6530 |
6531 /*********************************************************************** | |
6532 Initialization | |
6533 ***********************************************************************/ | |
6534 | |
21514 | 6535 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
6536 syms_of_display (void) |
314 | 6537 { |
764 | 6538 defsubr (&Sredraw_frame); |
314 | 6539 defsubr (&Sredraw_display); |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6540 defsubr (&Sframe_or_buffer_changed_p); |
314 | 6541 defsubr (&Sopen_termscript); |
6542 defsubr (&Sding); | |
71761
1055c0769159
* puresize.h (BASE_PURESIZE): Increment to 1211000.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
71573
diff
changeset
|
6543 defsubr (&Sredisplay); |
314 | 6544 defsubr (&Ssleep_for); |
6545 defsubr (&Ssend_string_to_terminal); | |
26280
083835afced5
(Finternal_show_cursor): Renamed from Fshow_cursor.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26164
diff
changeset
|
6546 defsubr (&Sinternal_show_cursor); |
26334
e3a9ceb7a557
(Finternal_show_cursor): Change it to set the
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
26280
diff
changeset
|
6547 defsubr (&Sinternal_show_cursor_p); |
95590
9a4b27c8feec
* window.el (display-buffer-function, special-display-p)
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
94963
diff
changeset
|
6548 defsubr (&Slast_nonminibuf_frame); |
314 | 6549 |
34893
779bd3fa820e
Use #if GLYPH_DEBUG instead of #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34866
diff
changeset
|
6550 #if GLYPH_DEBUG |
34866
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6551 defsubr (&Sdump_redisplay_history); |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6552 #endif |
4f47fc699608
(struct redisplay_history) [GLYPH_DEBUG]: New.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
34849
diff
changeset
|
6553 |
12186
6811992e871c
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): Calculate vector size right.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
11919
diff
changeset
|
6554 frame_and_buffer_state = Fmake_vector (make_number (20), Qlambda); |
7810
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6555 staticpro (&frame_and_buffer_state); |
15c0bf73737e
(Fframe_or_buffer_changed_p): New function.
Karl Heuer <kwzh@gnu.org>
parents:
7808
diff
changeset
|
6556 |
105877
21bdda3ded62
* xterm.c (syms_of_xterm):
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
6557 Qdisplay_table = intern_c_string ("display-table"); |
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6558 staticpro (&Qdisplay_table); |
105877
21bdda3ded62
* xterm.c (syms_of_xterm):
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
6559 Qredisplay_dont_pause = intern_c_string ("redisplay-dont-pause"); |
30720
64f3338f72d8
(Qredisplay_dont_pause): New variable.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
30713
diff
changeset
|
6560 staticpro (&Qredisplay_dont_pause); |
13220
2e9014617492
(Qdisplay_table): New variable.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13105
diff
changeset
|
6561 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6562 DEFVAR_INT ("baud-rate", &baud_rate, |
40979 | 6563 doc: /* *The output baud rate of the terminal. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6564 On most systems, changing this value will affect the amount of padding |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6565 and the other strategic decisions made during redisplay. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6566 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6567 DEFVAR_BOOL ("inverse-video", &inverse_video, |
40979 | 6568 doc: /* *Non-nil means invert the entire frame display. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6569 This means everything is in inverse video which otherwise would not be. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6570 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6571 DEFVAR_BOOL ("visible-bell", &visible_bell, |
40979 | 6572 doc: /* *Non-nil means try to flash the frame to represent a bell. |
40334
bee6cc2e8a90
(syms_of_display) <visible-bell>: Add a reference to
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
40271
diff
changeset
|
6573 |
bee6cc2e8a90
(syms_of_display) <visible-bell>: Add a reference to
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
40271
diff
changeset
|
6574 See also `ring-bell-function'. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6575 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6576 DEFVAR_BOOL ("no-redraw-on-reenter", &no_redraw_on_reenter, |
40979 | 6577 doc: /* *Non-nil means no need to redraw entire frame after suspending. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6578 A non-nil value is useful if the terminal can automatically preserve |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6579 Emacs's frame display when you reenter Emacs. |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6580 It is up to you to set this variable if your terminal can do that. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6581 |
83014
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
6582 DEFVAR_LISP ("initial-window-system", &Vinitial_window_system, |
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
6583 doc: /* Name of the window system that Emacs uses for the first frame. |
111155
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6584 The value is a symbol: |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6585 nil for a termcap frame (a character-only terminal), |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6586 'x' for an Emacs frame that is really an X window, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6587 'w32' for an Emacs frame that is a window on MS-Windows display, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6588 'ns' for an Emacs frame on a GNUstep or Macintosh Cocoa display, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6589 'pc' for a direct-write MS-DOS frame. |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6590 |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6591 Use of this variable as a boolean is deprecated. Instead, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6592 use `display-graphic-p' or any of the other `display-*-p' |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6593 predicates which report frame's specific UI-related capabilities. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6594 |
85614
9f3a25157e4f
Make `window-system' into a keyboard-local variable (rather than
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85252
diff
changeset
|
6595 DEFVAR_KBOARD ("window-system", Vwindow_system, |
9f3a25157e4f
Make `window-system' into a keyboard-local variable (rather than
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85252
diff
changeset
|
6596 doc: /* Name of window system through which the selected frame is displayed. |
111155
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6597 The value is a symbol: |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6598 nil for a termcap frame (a character-only terminal), |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6599 'x' for an Emacs frame that is really an X window, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6600 'w32' for an Emacs frame that is a window on MS-Windows display, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6601 'ns' for an Emacs frame on a GNUstep or Macintosh Cocoa display, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6602 'pc' for a direct-write MS-DOS frame. |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6603 |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6604 Use of this variable as a boolean is deprecated. Instead, |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6605 use `display-graphic-p' or any of the other `display-*-p' |
bfc9f85a0e9d
Document values of window-system and deprecate its use as predicate.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
6606 predicates which report frame's specific UI-related capabilities. */); |
85614
9f3a25157e4f
Make `window-system' into a keyboard-local variable (rather than
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85252
diff
changeset
|
6607 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6608 DEFVAR_LISP ("window-system-version", &Vwindow_system_version, |
40979 | 6609 doc: /* The version number of the window system in use. |
85826 | 6610 For X windows, this is 11. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6611 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6612 DEFVAR_BOOL ("cursor-in-echo-area", &cursor_in_echo_area, |
40979 | 6613 doc: /* Non-nil means put cursor in minibuffer, at end of any message there. */); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49322
diff
changeset
|
6614 |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6615 DEFVAR_LISP ("glyph-table", &Vglyph_table, |
40979 | 6616 doc: /* Table defining how to output a glyph code to the frame. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6617 If not nil, this is a vector indexed by glyph code to define the glyph. |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6618 Each element can be: |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6619 integer: a glyph code which this glyph is an alias for. |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6620 string: output this glyph using that string (not impl. in X windows). |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6621 nil: this glyph mod 524288 is the code of a character to output, |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6622 and this glyph / 524288 is the face number (see `face-id') to use |
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6623 while outputting it. */); |
314 | 6624 Vglyph_table = Qnil; |
6625 | |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6626 DEFVAR_LISP ("standard-display-table", &Vstandard_display_table, |
40979 | 6627 doc: /* Display table to use for buffers that specify none. |
39914
91951fb5b9e5
Put doc strings in comments.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents:
39682
diff
changeset
|
6628 See `buffer-display-table' for more information. */); |
314 | 6629 Vstandard_display_table = Qnil; |
6630 | |
39988
eac4e9ae201c
Change doc-string comments to `new style' [w/`doc:' keyword].
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents:
39954
diff
changeset
|
6631 DEFVAR_BOOL ("redisplay-dont-pause", &redisplay_dont_pause, |
40979 | 6632 doc: /* *Non-nil means update isn't paused when input is detected. */); |
25012 | 6633 redisplay_dont_pause = 0; |
6634 | |
71323
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6635 #if PERIODIC_PREEMPTION_CHECKING |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6636 DEFVAR_LISP ("redisplay-preemption-period", &Vredisplay_preemption_period, |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6637 doc: /* *The period in seconds between checking for input during redisplay. |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6638 If input is detected, redisplay is pre-empted, and the input is processed. |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6639 If nil, never pre-empt redisplay. */); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6640 Vredisplay_preemption_period = make_float (0.10); |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6641 #endif |
e882f189c3af
Modify preemptive redisplay to be based on periodic checks for input.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
71211
diff
changeset
|
6642 |
314 | 6643 #ifdef CANNOT_DUMP |
6644 if (noninteractive) | |
6645 #endif | |
6646 { | |
83014
f5cadabb36dd
Support for opening X frames from a tty session.
Karoly Lorentey <lorentey@elte.hu>
parents:
83010
diff
changeset
|
6647 Vinitial_window_system = Qnil; |
314 | 6648 Vwindow_system_version = Qnil; |
6649 } | |
6650 } | |
52401 | 6651 |
6652 /* arch-tag: 8d812b1f-04a2-4195-a9c4-381f8457a413 | |
6653 (do not change this comment) */ |